2008-12-08 05:17:03 +00:00
|
|
|
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
|
|
|
|
// Name: src/msw/window.cpp
|
|
|
|
// Purpose: wxWindowMSW
|
|
|
|
// Author: Julian Smart
|
|
|
|
// Modified by: VZ on 13.05.99: no more Default(), MSWOnXXX() reorganisation
|
|
|
|
// Created: 04/01/98
|
|
|
|
// RCS-ID: $Id: window.cpp 53929 2008-06-02 18:27:16Z RD $
|
|
|
|
// Copyright: (c) Julian Smart
|
|
|
|
// Licence: wxWindows licence
|
|
|
|
/////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
// declarations
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// headers
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// For compilers that support precompilation, includes "wx.h".
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/wxprec.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __BORLANDC__
|
|
|
|
#pragma hdrstop
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/window.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef WX_PRECOMP
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/wrapwin.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/wrapcctl.h" // include <commctrl.h> "properly"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/missing.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/accel.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/menu.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dc.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dcclient.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dcmemory.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/utils.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/app.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/layout.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dialog.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/frame.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/listbox.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/button.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msgdlg.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/settings.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/statbox.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/sizer.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/intl.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/log.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/textctrl.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/menuitem.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/module.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/ownerdrw.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/evtloop.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/power.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/sysopt.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dnd.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/access.h"
|
|
|
|
#include <ole2.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <oleacc.h>
|
|
|
|
#ifndef WM_GETOBJECT
|
|
|
|
#define WM_GETOBJECT 0x003D
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#ifndef OBJID_CLIENT
|
|
|
|
#define OBJID_CLIENT 0xFFFFFFFC
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/private.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/tooltip.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/caret.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_SPINCTRL
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/spinctrl.h"
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_SPINCTRL
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/notebook.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/listctrl.h"
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/dynlib.h"
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#include <string.h>
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if (!defined(__GNUWIN32_OLD__) && !defined(__WXMICROWIN__) /* && !defined(__WXWINCE__) */ ) || defined(__CYGWIN10__)
|
|
|
|
#include <shellapi.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <mmsystem.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WIN32__
|
|
|
|
#include <windowsx.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined __WXWINCE__ && !defined NEED_PBT_H
|
|
|
|
#include <pbt.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/wince/missing.h"
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __POCKETPC__
|
|
|
|
#include <windows.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <shellapi.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <ole2.h>
|
|
|
|
#include <aygshell.h>
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_UXTHEME
|
|
|
|
#include "wx/msw/uxtheme.h"
|
|
|
|
#define EP_EDITTEXT 1
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_NORMAL 1
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_HOT 2
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_SELECTED 3
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_DISABLED 4
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_FOCUSED 5
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_READONLY 6
|
|
|
|
#define ETS_ASSIST 7
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(TME_LEAVE) && defined(WM_MOUSELEAVE) && wxUSE_DYNLIB_CLASS
|
|
|
|
#define HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
#endif // everything needed for TrackMouseEvent()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if this is set to 1, we use deferred window sizing to reduce flicker when
|
|
|
|
// resizing complicated window hierarchies, but this can in theory result in
|
|
|
|
// different behaviour than the old code so we keep the possibility to use it
|
|
|
|
// by setting this to 0 (in the future this should be removed completely)
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
#define USE_DEFERRED_SIZING 0
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
#define USE_DEFERRED_SIZING 1
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// set this to 1 to filter out duplicate mouse events, e.g. mouse move events
|
|
|
|
// when mouse position didnd't change
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
#define wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK 0
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
#define wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK 1
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// global variables
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
wxMenu *wxCurrentPopupMenu = NULL;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
extern wxChar *wxCanvasClassName;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxCanvasClassName;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// true if we had already created the std colour map, used by
|
|
|
|
// wxGetStdColourMap() and wxWindow::OnSysColourChanged() (FIXME-MT)
|
|
|
|
static bool gs_hasStdCmap = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// last mouse event information we need to filter out the duplicates
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
static struct MouseEventInfoDummy
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// mouse position (in screen coordinates)
|
|
|
|
wxPoint pos;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// last mouse event type
|
|
|
|
wxEventType type;
|
|
|
|
} gs_lastMouseEvent;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// private functions
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the window proc for all our windows
|
|
|
|
LRESULT WXDLLEXPORT APIENTRY _EXPORT wxWndProc(HWND hWnd, UINT message,
|
|
|
|
WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
const wxChar *wxGetMessageName(int message);
|
|
|
|
#endif //__WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxRemoveHandleAssociation(wxWindowMSW *win);
|
|
|
|
extern void wxAssociateWinWithHandle(HWND hWnd, wxWindowMSW *win);
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxFindWinFromHandle(WXHWND hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// get the text metrics for the current font
|
|
|
|
static TEXTMETRIC wxGetTextMetrics(const wxWindowMSW *win);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// find the window for the mouse event at the specified position
|
|
|
|
static wxWindowMSW *FindWindowForMouseEvent(wxWindowMSW *win, int *x, int *y);
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// wrapper around BringWindowToTop() API
|
|
|
|
static inline void wxBringWindowToTop(HWND hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
// It seems that MicroWindows brings the _parent_ of the window to the top,
|
|
|
|
// which can be the wrong one.
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// activate (set focus to) specified window
|
|
|
|
::SetFocus(hwnd);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// raise top level parent to top of z order
|
|
|
|
if (!::SetWindowPos(hwnd, HWND_TOP, 0, 0, 0, 0, SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("SetWindowPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ensure that all our parent windows have WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT style
|
|
|
|
static void EnsureParentHasControlParentStyle(wxWindow *parent)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
If we have WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT flag we absolutely *must* set it for our
|
|
|
|
parent as well as otherwise several Win32 functions using
|
|
|
|
GetNextDlgTabItem() to iterate over all controls such as
|
|
|
|
IsDialogMessage() or DefDlgProc() would enter an infinite loop: indeed,
|
|
|
|
all of them iterate over all the controls starting from the currently
|
|
|
|
focused one and stop iterating when they get back to the focus but
|
|
|
|
unless all parents have WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT bit set, they would never
|
|
|
|
get back to the initial (focused) window: as we do have this style,
|
|
|
|
GetNextDlgTabItem() will leave this window and continue in its parent,
|
|
|
|
but if the parent doesn't have it, it wouldn't recurse inside it later
|
|
|
|
on and so wouldn't have a chance of getting back to this window either.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
while ( parent && !parent->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
LONG exStyle = ::GetWindowLong(GetHwndOf(parent), GWL_EXSTYLE);
|
|
|
|
if ( !(exStyle & WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// force the parent to have this style
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowLong(GetHwndOf(parent), GWL_EXSTYLE,
|
|
|
|
exStyle | WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
parent = parent->GetParent();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// On Windows CE, GetCursorPos can return an error, so use this function
|
|
|
|
// instead
|
|
|
|
bool GetCursorPosWinCE(POINT* pt)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!GetCursorPos(pt))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
DWORD pos = GetMessagePos();
|
|
|
|
pt->x = LOWORD(pos);
|
|
|
|
pt->y = HIWORD(pos);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static wxBorder TranslateBorder(wxBorder border)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( border == wxBORDER_THEME )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__POCKETPC__) || defined(__SMARTPHONE__)
|
|
|
|
return wxBORDER_SIMPLE;
|
|
|
|
#elif wxUSE_UXTHEME
|
|
|
|
if (wxUxThemeEngine::GetIfActive())
|
|
|
|
return wxBORDER_THEME;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
return wxBORDER_SUNKEN;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return border;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// event tables
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// in wxUniv/MSW this class is abstract because it doesn't have DoPopupMenu()
|
|
|
|
// method
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
IMPLEMENT_ABSTRACT_CLASS(wxWindowMSW, wxWindowBase)
|
|
|
|
#else // __WXMSW__
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_EXTENDED_RTTI
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// windows that are created from a parent window during its Create method, eg. spin controls in a calendar controls
|
|
|
|
// must never been streamed out separately otherwise chaos occurs. Right now easiest is to test for negative ids, as
|
|
|
|
// windows with negative ids never can be recreated anyway
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowStreamingCallback( const wxObject *object, wxWriter * , wxPersister * , wxxVariantArray & )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const wxWindow * win = dynamic_cast<const wxWindow*>(object) ;
|
|
|
|
if ( win && win->GetId() < 0 )
|
|
|
|
return false ;
|
|
|
|
return true ;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS_XTI_CALLBACK(wxWindow, wxWindowBase,"wx/window.h", wxWindowStreamingCallback)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// make wxWindowList known before the property is used
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCOLLECTION_TYPE_INFO( wxWindow* , wxWindowList ) ;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
template<> void wxCollectionToVariantArray( wxWindowList const &theList, wxxVariantArray &value)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxListCollectionToVariantArray<wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator>( theList , value ) ;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WX_DEFINE_FLAGS( wxWindowStyle )
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxBEGIN_FLAGS( wxWindowStyle )
|
|
|
|
// new style border flags, we put them first to
|
|
|
|
// use them for streaming out
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SIMPLE)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_SUNKEN)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_DOUBLE)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_RAISED)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_STATIC)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER_NONE)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// old style border flags
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSIMPLE_BORDER)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSUNKEN_BORDER)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxDOUBLE_BORDER)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxRAISED_BORDER)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxSTATIC_BORDER)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxBORDER)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// standard window styles
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTAB_TRAVERSAL)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxCLIP_CHILDREN)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxTRANSPARENT_WINDOW)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxWANTS_CHARS)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxFULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxALWAYS_SHOW_SB )
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxVSCROLL)
|
|
|
|
wxFLAGS_MEMBER(wxHSCROLL)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxEND_FLAGS( wxWindowStyle )
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxBEGIN_PROPERTIES_TABLE(wxWindow)
|
|
|
|
wxEVENT_PROPERTY( Close , wxEVT_CLOSE_WINDOW , wxCloseEvent)
|
|
|
|
wxEVENT_PROPERTY( Create , wxEVT_CREATE , wxWindowCreateEvent )
|
|
|
|
wxEVENT_PROPERTY( Destroy , wxEVT_DESTROY , wxWindowDestroyEvent )
|
|
|
|
// Always constructor Properties first
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxREADONLY_PROPERTY( Parent,wxWindow*, GetParent, EMPTY_MACROVALUE , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group"))
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Id,wxWindowID, SetId, GetId, -1 /*wxID_ANY*/ , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group") )
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Position,wxPoint, SetPosition , GetPosition, wxDefaultPosition , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // pos
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Size,wxSize, SetSize, GetSize, wxDefaultSize , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // size
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( WindowStyle , long , SetWindowStyleFlag , GetWindowStyleFlag , EMPTY_MACROVALUE , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // style
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Then all relations of the object graph
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxREADONLY_PROPERTY_COLLECTION( Children , wxWindowList , wxWindowBase* , GetWindowChildren , wxPROP_OBJECT_GRAPH /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group"))
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and finally all other properties
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( ExtraStyle , long , SetExtraStyle , GetExtraStyle , EMPTY_MACROVALUE , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // extstyle
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( BackgroundColour , wxColour , SetBackgroundColour , GetBackgroundColour , EMPTY_MACROVALUE , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // bg
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( ForegroundColour , wxColour , SetForegroundColour , GetForegroundColour , EMPTY_MACROVALUE , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group")) // fg
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Enabled , bool , Enable , IsEnabled , wxxVariant((bool)true) , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group"))
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Shown , bool , Show , IsShown , wxxVariant((bool)true) , 0 /*flags*/ , wxT("Helpstring") , wxT("group"))
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
|
|
|
// possible property candidates (not in xrc) or not valid in all subclasses
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Title,wxString, SetTitle, GetTitle, wxEmptyString )
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Font , wxFont , SetFont , GetWindowFont , )
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( Label,wxString, SetLabel, GetLabel, wxEmptyString )
|
|
|
|
// MaxHeight, Width , MinHeight , Width
|
|
|
|
// TODO switch label to control and title to toplevels
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( ThemeEnabled , bool , SetThemeEnabled , GetThemeEnabled , )
|
|
|
|
//wxPROPERTY( Cursor , wxCursor , SetCursor , GetCursor , )
|
|
|
|
// wxPROPERTY( ToolTip , wxString , SetToolTip , GetToolTipText , )
|
|
|
|
wxPROPERTY( AutoLayout , bool , SetAutoLayout , GetAutoLayout , )
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
wxEND_PROPERTIES_TABLE()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxBEGIN_HANDLERS_TABLE(wxWindow)
|
|
|
|
wxEND_HANDLERS_TABLE()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCONSTRUCTOR_DUMMY(wxWindow)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxWindow, wxWindowBase)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__/__WXMSW__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
BEGIN_EVENT_TABLE(wxWindowMSW, wxWindowBase)
|
|
|
|
EVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED(wxWindowMSW::OnSysColourChanged)
|
|
|
|
EVT_ERASE_BACKGROUND(wxWindowMSW::OnEraseBackground)
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
EVT_INIT_DIALOG(wxWindowMSW::OnInitDialog)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
END_EVENT_TABLE()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
// implementation
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// wxWindow utility functions
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Find an item given the MS Windows id
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxWindowMSW::FindItem(long id) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
wxControl *item = wxDynamicCastThis(wxControl);
|
|
|
|
if ( item )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// is it us or one of our "internal" children?
|
|
|
|
if ( item->GetId() == id
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
|| (item->GetSubcontrols().Index(id) != wxNOT_FOUND)
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return item;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator current = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while (current)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *childWin = current->GetData();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wnd = childWin->FindItem(id);
|
|
|
|
if ( wnd )
|
|
|
|
return wnd;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current = current->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Find an item given the MS Windows handle
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxWindowMSW::FindItemByHWND(WXHWND hWnd, bool controlOnly) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator current = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while (current)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *parent = current->GetData();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Do a recursive search.
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wnd = parent->FindItemByHWND(hWnd);
|
|
|
|
if ( wnd )
|
|
|
|
return wnd;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !controlOnly
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
|| parent->IsKindOf(CLASSINFO(wxControl))
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *item = current->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( item->GetHWND() == hWnd )
|
|
|
|
return item;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( item->ContainsHWND(hWnd) )
|
|
|
|
return item;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
current = current->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Default command handler
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWCommand(WXUINT WXUNUSED(param), WXWORD WXUNUSED(id))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// constructors and such
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Init()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// MSW specific
|
|
|
|
m_isBeingDeleted = false;
|
|
|
|
m_oldWndProc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
m_mouseInWindow = false;
|
|
|
|
m_lastKeydownProcessed = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_childrenDisabled = NULL;
|
|
|
|
m_frozenness = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_hWnd = 0;
|
|
|
|
m_hDWP = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_xThumbSize = 0;
|
|
|
|
m_yThumbSize = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_pendingPosition = wxDefaultPosition;
|
|
|
|
m_pendingSize = wxDefaultSize;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __POCKETPC__
|
|
|
|
m_contextMenuEnabled = false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Destructor
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::~wxWindowMSW()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_isBeingDeleted = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
// VS: make sure there's no wxFrame with last focus set to us:
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindow *win = GetParent(); win; win = win->GetParent() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxTopLevelWindow *frame = wxDynamicCast(win, wxTopLevelWindow);
|
|
|
|
if ( frame )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( frame->GetLastFocus() == this )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
frame->SetLastFocus(NULL);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// apparently sometimes we can end up with our grand parent
|
|
|
|
// pointing to us as well: this is surely a bug in focus handling
|
|
|
|
// code but it's not clear where it happens so for now just try to
|
|
|
|
// fix it here by not breaking out of the loop
|
|
|
|
//break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// VS: destroy children first and _then_ detach *this from its parent.
|
|
|
|
// If we did it the other way around, children wouldn't be able
|
|
|
|
// find their parent frame (see above).
|
|
|
|
DestroyChildren();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( m_hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// VZ: test temp removed to understand what really happens here
|
|
|
|
//if (::IsWindow(GetHwnd()))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::DestroyWindow(GetHwnd()) )
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("DestroyWindow"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// remove hWnd <-> wxWindow association
|
|
|
|
wxRemoveHandleAssociation(this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete m_childrenDisabled;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// real construction (Init() must have been called before!)
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::Create(wxWindow *parent,
|
|
|
|
wxWindowID id,
|
|
|
|
const wxPoint& pos,
|
|
|
|
const wxSize& size,
|
|
|
|
long style,
|
|
|
|
const wxString& name)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( parent, false, wxT("can't create wxWindow without parent") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !CreateBase(parent, id, pos, size, style, wxDefaultValidator, name) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
parent->AddChild(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD exstyle;
|
|
|
|
DWORD msflags = MSWGetCreateWindowFlags(&exstyle);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
// no borders, we draw them ourselves
|
|
|
|
exstyle &= ~(WS_EX_DLGMODALFRAME |
|
|
|
|
WS_EX_STATICEDGE |
|
|
|
|
WS_EX_CLIENTEDGE |
|
|
|
|
WS_EX_WINDOWEDGE);
|
|
|
|
msflags &= ~WS_BORDER;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUniversal
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( IsShown() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
msflags |= WS_VISIBLE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !MSWCreate(wxCanvasClassName, NULL, pos, size, msflags, exstyle) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
InheritAttributes();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// basic operations
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetFocus()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( hWnd, _T("can't set focus to invalid window") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXMICROWIN__) && !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
::SetLastError(0);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !::SetFocus(hWnd) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__WXDEBUG__) && !defined(__WXMICROWIN__)
|
|
|
|
// was there really an error?
|
|
|
|
DWORD dwRes = ::GetLastError();
|
|
|
|
if ( dwRes )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hwndFocus = ::GetFocus();
|
|
|
|
if ( hwndFocus != hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogApiError(_T("SetFocus"), dwRes);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // Debug
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetFocusFromKbd()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// when the focus is given to the control with DLGC_HASSETSEL style from
|
|
|
|
// keyboard its contents should be entirely selected: this is what
|
|
|
|
// ::IsDialogMessage() does and so we should do it as well to provide the
|
|
|
|
// same LNF as the native programs
|
|
|
|
if ( ::SendMessage(GetHwnd(), WM_GETDLGCODE, 0, 0) & DLGC_HASSETSEL )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(GetHwnd(), EM_SETSEL, 0, -1);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// do this after (maybe) setting the selection as like this when
|
|
|
|
// wxEVT_SET_FOCUS handler is called, the selection would have been already
|
|
|
|
// set correctly -- this may be important
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::SetFocusFromKbd();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Get the window with the focus
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxWindowBase::DoFindFocus()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = ::GetFocus();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return wxGetWindowFromHWND((WXHWND)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::Enable(bool enable)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxWindowBase::Enable(enable) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
::EnableWindow(hWnd, (BOOL)enable);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the logic below doesn't apply to the top level windows -- otherwise
|
|
|
|
// showing a modal dialog would result in total greying out (and ungreying
|
|
|
|
// out later) of everything which would be really ugly
|
|
|
|
if ( IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// when the parent is disabled, all of its children should be disabled as
|
|
|
|
// well but when it is enabled back, only those of the children which
|
|
|
|
// hadn't been already disabled in the beginning should be enabled again,
|
|
|
|
// so we have to keep the list of those children
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *child = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( child->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// the logic below doesn't apply to top level children
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( enable )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// re-enable the child unless it had been disabled before us
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_childrenDisabled || !m_childrenDisabled->Find(child) )
|
|
|
|
child->Enable();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // we're being disabled
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( child->IsEnabled() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// disable it as children shouldn't stay enabled while the
|
|
|
|
// parent is not
|
|
|
|
child->Disable();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // child already disabled, remember it
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// have we created the list of disabled children already?
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_childrenDisabled )
|
|
|
|
m_childrenDisabled = new wxWindowList;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_childrenDisabled->Append(child);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( enable && m_childrenDisabled )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we don't need this list any more, don't keep unused memory
|
|
|
|
delete m_childrenDisabled;
|
|
|
|
m_childrenDisabled = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::Show(bool show)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxWindowBase::Show(show) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we could be called before the underlying window is created (this is
|
|
|
|
// actually useful to prevent it from being initially shown), e.g.
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// wxFoo *foo = new wxFoo;
|
|
|
|
// foo->Hide();
|
|
|
|
// foo->Create(parent, ...);
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// should work without errors
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::ShowWindow(hWnd, show ? SW_SHOW : SW_HIDE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Raise the window to the top of the Z order
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Raise()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxBringWindowToTop(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Lower the window to the bottom of the Z order
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Lower()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowPos(GetHwnd(), HWND_BOTTOM, 0, 0, 0, 0,
|
|
|
|
SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE | SWP_NOACTIVATE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoCaptureMouse()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SetCapture(hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoReleaseMouse()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::ReleaseCapture() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("ReleaseCapture"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/* static */ wxWindow *wxWindowBase::GetCapture()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = ::GetCapture();
|
|
|
|
return hwnd ? wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)hwnd) : (wxWindow *)NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::SetFont(const wxFont& font)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxWindowBase::SetFont(font) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// nothing to do
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd != 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WXHANDLE hFont = m_font.GetResourceHandle();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( hFont, wxT("should have valid font") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(hWnd, WM_SETFONT, (WPARAM)hFont, MAKELPARAM(TRUE, 0));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::SetCursor(const wxCursor& cursor)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxWindowBase::SetCursor(cursor) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// no change
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't "overwrite" busy cursor
|
|
|
|
if ( m_cursor.Ok() && !wxIsBusy() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// normally we should change the cursor only if it's over this window
|
|
|
|
// but we should do it always if we capture the mouse currently
|
|
|
|
bool set = HasCapture();
|
|
|
|
if ( !set )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
POINT point;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
::GetCursorPosWinCE(&point);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
::GetCursorPos(&point);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RECT rect = wxGetWindowRect(hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
set = ::PtInRect(&rect, point) != 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( set )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SetCursor(GetHcursorOf(m_cursor));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//else: will be set later when the mouse enters this window
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::WarpPointer(int x, int y)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
ClientToScreen(&x, &y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !::SetCursorPos(x, y) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("SetCursorPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::MSWUpdateUIState(int action, int state)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// WM_CHANGEUISTATE only appeared in Windows 2000 so it can do us no good
|
|
|
|
// to use it on older systems -- and could possibly do some harm
|
|
|
|
static int s_needToUpdate = -1;
|
|
|
|
if ( s_needToUpdate == -1 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int verMaj, verMin;
|
|
|
|
s_needToUpdate = wxGetOsVersion(&verMaj, &verMin) == wxOS_WINDOWS_NT &&
|
|
|
|
verMaj >= 5;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( s_needToUpdate )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we send WM_CHANGEUISTATE so if nothing needs changing then the system
|
|
|
|
// won't send WM_UPDATEUISTATE
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(GetHwnd(), WM_CHANGEUISTATE, MAKEWPARAM(action, state), 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// scrolling stuff
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
inline int GetScrollPosition(HWND hWnd, int wOrient)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
return ::GetScrollPosWX(hWnd, wOrient);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<SCROLLINFO> scrollInfo;
|
|
|
|
scrollInfo.cbSize = sizeof(SCROLLINFO);
|
|
|
|
scrollInfo.fMask = SIF_POS;
|
|
|
|
::GetScrollInfo(hWnd, wOrient, &scrollInfo );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return scrollInfo.nPos;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::GetScrollPos(int orient) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( hWnd, 0, _T("no HWND in GetScrollPos") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetScrollPosition(hWnd, orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ : SB_VERT);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// This now returns the whole range, not just the number
|
|
|
|
// of positions that we can scroll.
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::GetScrollRange(int orient) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int maxPos;
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( !hWnd )
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
|
|
|
::GetScrollRange(hWnd, orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ : SB_VERT,
|
|
|
|
&minPos, &maxPos);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<SCROLLINFO> scrollInfo;
|
|
|
|
scrollInfo.fMask = SIF_RANGE;
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetScrollInfo(hWnd,
|
|
|
|
orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ : SB_VERT,
|
|
|
|
&scrollInfo) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Most of the time this is not really an error, since the return
|
|
|
|
// value can also be zero when there is no scrollbar yet.
|
|
|
|
// wxLogLastError(_T("GetScrollInfo"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
maxPos = scrollInfo.nMax;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// undo "range - 1" done in SetScrollbar()
|
|
|
|
return maxPos + 1;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::GetScrollThumb(int orient) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? m_xThumbSize : m_yThumbSize;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetScrollPos(int orient, int pos, bool refresh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( hWnd, _T("SetScrollPos: no HWND") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<SCROLLINFO> info;
|
|
|
|
info.nPage = 0;
|
|
|
|
info.nMin = 0;
|
|
|
|
info.nPos = pos;
|
|
|
|
info.fMask = SIF_POS;
|
|
|
|
if ( HasFlag(wxALWAYS_SHOW_SB) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// disable scrollbar instead of removing it then
|
|
|
|
info.fMask |= SIF_DISABLENOSCROLL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetScrollInfo(hWnd, orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ : SB_VERT,
|
|
|
|
&info, refresh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// New function that will replace some of the above.
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetScrollbar(int orient,
|
|
|
|
int pos,
|
|
|
|
int pageSize,
|
|
|
|
int range,
|
|
|
|
bool refresh)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<SCROLLINFO> info;
|
|
|
|
info.nPage = pageSize;
|
|
|
|
info.nMin = 0; // range is nMax - nMin + 1
|
|
|
|
info.nMax = range - 1; // as both nMax and nMax are inclusive
|
|
|
|
info.nPos = pos;
|
|
|
|
info.fMask = SIF_RANGE | SIF_PAGE | SIF_POS;
|
|
|
|
if ( HasFlag(wxALWAYS_SHOW_SB) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// disable scrollbar instead of removing it then
|
|
|
|
info.fMask |= SIF_DISABLENOSCROLL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// We have to set the variables here to make them valid in events
|
|
|
|
// triggered by ::SetScrollInfo()
|
|
|
|
*(orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? &m_xThumbSize : &m_yThumbSize) = pageSize;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetScrollInfo(hWnd, orient == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ : SB_VERT,
|
|
|
|
&info, refresh);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::ScrollWindow(int dx, int dy, const wxRect *prect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT rect;
|
|
|
|
RECT *pr;
|
|
|
|
if ( prect )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
rect.left = prect->x;
|
|
|
|
rect.top = prect->y;
|
|
|
|
rect.right = prect->x + prect->width;
|
|
|
|
rect.bottom = prect->y + prect->height;
|
|
|
|
pr = ▭
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
pr = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: is this the exact equivalent of the line below?
|
|
|
|
::ScrollWindowEx(GetHwnd(), dx, dy, pr, pr, 0, 0, SW_SCROLLCHILDREN|SW_ERASE|SW_INVALIDATE);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
::ScrollWindow(GetHwnd(), dx, dy, pr, pr);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static bool ScrollVertically(HWND hwnd, int kind, int count)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int posStart = GetScrollPosition(hwnd, SB_VERT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int pos = posStart;
|
|
|
|
for ( int n = 0; n < count; n++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(hwnd, WM_VSCROLL, kind, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int posNew = GetScrollPosition(hwnd, SB_VERT);
|
|
|
|
if ( posNew == pos )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// don't bother to continue, we're already at top/bottom
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pos = posNew;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return pos != posStart;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::ScrollLines(int lines)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool down = lines > 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return ScrollVertically(GetHwnd(),
|
|
|
|
down ? SB_LINEDOWN : SB_LINEUP,
|
|
|
|
down ? lines : -lines);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::ScrollPages(int pages)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool down = pages > 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return ScrollVertically(GetHwnd(),
|
|
|
|
down ? SB_PAGEDOWN : SB_PAGEUP,
|
|
|
|
down ? pages : -pages);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// RTL support
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetLayoutDirection(wxLayoutDirection dir)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(dir);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
const HWND hwnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( hwnd, _T("layout direction must be set after window creation") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LONG styleOld = ::GetWindowLong(hwnd, GWL_EXSTYLE);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LONG styleNew = styleOld;
|
|
|
|
switch ( dir )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case wxLayout_LeftToRight:
|
|
|
|
styleNew &= ~WS_EX_LAYOUTRTL;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case wxLayout_RightToLeft:
|
|
|
|
styleNew |= WS_EX_LAYOUTRTL;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
wxFAIL_MSG(_T("unsupported layout direction"));
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( styleNew != styleOld )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowLong(hwnd, GWL_EXSTYLE, styleNew);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxLayoutDirection wxWindowMSW::GetLayoutDirection() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
return wxLayout_Default;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
const HWND hwnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( hwnd, wxLayout_Default, _T("invalid window") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return ::GetWindowLong(hwnd, GWL_EXSTYLE) & WS_EX_LAYOUTRTL
|
|
|
|
? wxLayout_RightToLeft
|
|
|
|
: wxLayout_LeftToRight;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCoord
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::AdjustForLayoutDirection(wxCoord x,
|
|
|
|
wxCoord WXUNUSED(width),
|
|
|
|
wxCoord WXUNUSED(widthTotal)) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Win32 mirrors the coordinates of RTL windows automatically, so don't
|
|
|
|
// redo it ourselves
|
|
|
|
return x;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// subclassing
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SubclassWin(WXHWND hWnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( !m_oldWndProc, wxT("subclassing window twice?") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = (HWND)hWnd;
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( ::IsWindow(hwnd), wxT("invalid HWND in SubclassWin") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxAssociateWinWithHandle(hwnd, this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_oldWndProc = (WXFARPROC)wxGetWindowProc((HWND)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we don't need to subclass the window of our own class (in the Windows
|
|
|
|
// sense of the word)
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxCheckWindowWndProc(hWnd, (WXFARPROC)wxWndProc) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxSetWindowProc(hwnd, wxWndProc);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// don't bother restoring it either: this also makes it easy to
|
|
|
|
// implement IsOfStandardClass() method which returns true for the
|
|
|
|
// standard controls and false for the wxWidgets own windows as it can
|
|
|
|
// simply check m_oldWndProc
|
|
|
|
m_oldWndProc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we're officially created now, send the event
|
|
|
|
wxWindowCreateEvent event((wxWindow *)this);
|
|
|
|
(void)GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnsubclassWin()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxRemoveHandleAssociation(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Restore old Window proc
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hwnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SetHWND(0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( ::IsWindow(hwnd), wxT("invalid HWND in UnsubclassWin") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( m_oldWndProc )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxCheckWindowWndProc((WXHWND)hwnd, m_oldWndProc) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxSetWindowProc(hwnd, (WNDPROC)m_oldWndProc);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_oldWndProc = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::AssociateHandle(WXWidget handle)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( m_hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::DestroyWindow(GetHwnd()) )
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("DestroyWindow"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXHWND wxhwnd = (WXHWND)handle;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SetHWND(wxhwnd);
|
|
|
|
SubclassWin(wxhwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DissociateHandle()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// this also calls SetHWND(0) for us
|
|
|
|
UnsubclassWin();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxCheckWindowWndProc(WXHWND hWnd,
|
|
|
|
WXFARPROC WXUNUSED(wndProc))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// TODO: This list of window class names should be factored out so they can be
|
|
|
|
// managed in one place and then accessed from here and other places, such as
|
|
|
|
// wxApp::RegisterWindowClasses() and wxApp::UnregisterWindowClasses()
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
extern wxChar *wxCanvasClassName;
|
|
|
|
extern wxChar *wxCanvasClassNameNR;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxCanvasClassName;
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxCanvasClassNameNR;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxMDIFrameClassName;
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxMDIFrameClassNameNoRedraw;
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxMDIChildFrameClassName;
|
|
|
|
extern const wxChar *wxMDIChildFrameClassNameNoRedraw;
|
|
|
|
wxString str(wxGetWindowClass(hWnd));
|
|
|
|
if (str == wxCanvasClassName ||
|
|
|
|
str == wxCanvasClassNameNR ||
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_GLCANVAS
|
|
|
|
str == _T("wxGLCanvasClass") ||
|
|
|
|
str == _T("wxGLCanvasClassNR") ||
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_GLCANVAS
|
|
|
|
str == wxMDIFrameClassName ||
|
|
|
|
str == wxMDIFrameClassNameNoRedraw ||
|
|
|
|
str == wxMDIChildFrameClassName ||
|
|
|
|
str == wxMDIChildFrameClassNameNoRedraw ||
|
|
|
|
str == _T("wxTLWHiddenParent"))
|
|
|
|
return true; // Effectively means don't subclass
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Style handling
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetWindowStyleFlag(long flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
long flagsOld = GetWindowStyleFlag();
|
|
|
|
if ( flags == flagsOld )
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// update the internal variable
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::SetWindowStyleFlag(flags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and the real window flags
|
|
|
|
MSWUpdateStyle(flagsOld, GetExtraStyle());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetExtraStyle(long exflags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
long exflagsOld = GetExtraStyle();
|
|
|
|
if ( exflags == exflagsOld )
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// update the internal variable
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::SetExtraStyle(exflags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and the real window flags
|
|
|
|
MSWUpdateStyle(GetWindowStyleFlag(), exflagsOld);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::MSWUpdateStyle(long flagsOld, long exflagsOld)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// now update the Windows style as well if needed - and if the window had
|
|
|
|
// been already created
|
|
|
|
if ( !GetHwnd() )
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we may need to call SetWindowPos() when we change some styles
|
|
|
|
bool callSWP = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD exstyle;
|
|
|
|
long style = MSWGetStyle(GetWindowStyleFlag(), &exstyle);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// this is quite a horrible hack but we need it because MSWGetStyle()
|
|
|
|
// doesn't take exflags as parameter but uses GetExtraStyle() internally
|
|
|
|
// and so we have to modify the window exflags temporarily to get the
|
|
|
|
// correct exstyleOld
|
|
|
|
long exflagsNew = GetExtraStyle();
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::SetExtraStyle(exflagsOld);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD exstyleOld;
|
|
|
|
long styleOld = MSWGetStyle(flagsOld, &exstyleOld);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::SetExtraStyle(exflagsNew);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( style != styleOld )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// some flags (e.g. WS_VISIBLE or WS_DISABLED) should not be changed by
|
|
|
|
// this function so instead of simply setting the style to the new
|
|
|
|
// value we clear the bits which were set in styleOld but are set in
|
|
|
|
// the new one and set the ones which were not set before
|
|
|
|
long styleReal = ::GetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_STYLE);
|
|
|
|
styleReal &= ~styleOld;
|
|
|
|
styleReal |= style;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_STYLE, styleReal);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we need to call SetWindowPos() if any of the styles affecting the
|
|
|
|
// frame appearance have changed
|
|
|
|
callSWP = ((styleOld ^ style ) & (WS_BORDER |
|
|
|
|
WS_THICKFRAME |
|
|
|
|
WS_CAPTION |
|
|
|
|
WS_DLGFRAME |
|
|
|
|
WS_MAXIMIZEBOX |
|
|
|
|
WS_MINIMIZEBOX |
|
|
|
|
WS_SYSMENU) ) != 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and the extended style
|
|
|
|
long exstyleReal = ::GetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_EXSTYLE);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( exstyle != exstyleOld )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
exstyleReal &= ~exstyleOld;
|
|
|
|
exstyleReal |= exstyle;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_EXSTYLE, exstyleReal);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ex style changes don't take effect without calling SetWindowPos
|
|
|
|
callSWP = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( callSWP )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we must call SetWindowPos() to flush the cached extended style and
|
|
|
|
// also to make the change to wxSTAY_ON_TOP style take effect: just
|
|
|
|
// setting the style simply doesn't work
|
|
|
|
if ( !::SetWindowPos(GetHwnd(),
|
|
|
|
exstyleReal & WS_EX_TOPMOST ? HWND_TOPMOST
|
|
|
|
: HWND_NOTOPMOST,
|
|
|
|
0, 0, 0, 0,
|
|
|
|
SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE | SWP_FRAMECHANGED) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("SetWindowPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD wxWindowMSW::MSWGetStyle(long flags, WXDWORD *exstyle) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// translate common wxWidgets styles to Windows ones
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// most of windows are child ones, those which are not (such as
|
|
|
|
// wxTopLevelWindow) should remove WS_CHILD in their MSWGetStyle()
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD style = WS_CHILD;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// using this flag results in very significant reduction in flicker,
|
|
|
|
// especially with controls inside the static boxes (as the interior of the
|
|
|
|
// box is not redrawn twice), but sometimes results in redraw problems, so
|
|
|
|
// optionally allow the old code to continue to use it provided a special
|
|
|
|
// system option is turned on
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxSystemOptions::GetOptionInt(wxT("msw.window.no-clip-children"))
|
|
|
|
|| (flags & wxCLIP_CHILDREN) )
|
|
|
|
style |= WS_CLIPCHILDREN;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// it doesn't seem useful to use WS_CLIPSIBLINGS here as we officially
|
|
|
|
// don't support overlapping windows and it only makes sense for them and,
|
|
|
|
// presumably, gives the system some extra work (to manage more clipping
|
|
|
|
// regions), so avoid it alltogether
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & wxVSCROLL )
|
|
|
|
style |= WS_VSCROLL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & wxHSCROLL )
|
|
|
|
style |= WS_HSCROLL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const wxBorder border = TranslateBorder(GetBorder(flags));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// WS_BORDER is only required for wxBORDER_SIMPLE
|
|
|
|
if ( border == wxBORDER_SIMPLE )
|
|
|
|
style |= WS_BORDER;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// now deal with ext style if the caller wants it
|
|
|
|
if ( exstyle )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*exstyle = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & wxTRANSPARENT_WINDOW )
|
|
|
|
*exstyle |= WS_EX_TRANSPARENT;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch ( border )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_DEFAULT:
|
|
|
|
wxFAIL_MSG( _T("unknown border style") );
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_NONE:
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_SIMPLE:
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_THEME:
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_STATIC:
|
|
|
|
*exstyle |= WS_EX_STATICEDGE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_RAISED:
|
|
|
|
*exstyle |= WS_EX_DLGMODALFRAME;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case wxBORDER_SUNKEN:
|
|
|
|
*exstyle |= WS_EX_CLIENTEDGE;
|
|
|
|
style &= ~WS_BORDER;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// case wxBORDER_DOUBLE:
|
|
|
|
// *exstyle |= WS_EX_DLGMODALFRAME;
|
|
|
|
// break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// wxUniv doesn't use Windows dialog navigation functions at all
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__) && !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
// to make the dialog navigation work with the nested panels we must
|
|
|
|
// use this style (top level windows such as dialogs don't need it)
|
|
|
|
if ( (flags & wxTAB_TRAVERSAL) && !IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*exstyle |= WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return style;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Helper for getting an appropriate theme style for the application. Unnecessary in
|
|
|
|
// 2.9 and above.
|
|
|
|
wxBorder wxWindowMSW::GetThemedBorderStyle() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return TranslateBorder(wxBORDER_THEME);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Setup background and foreground colours correctly
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetupColours()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( GetParent() )
|
|
|
|
SetBackgroundColour(GetParent()->GetBackgroundColour());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::IsMouseInWindow() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// get the mouse position
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
::GetCursorPosWinCE(&pt);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
::GetCursorPos(&pt);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// find the window which currently has the cursor and go up the window
|
|
|
|
// chain until we find this window - or exhaust it
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = ::WindowFromPoint(pt);
|
|
|
|
while ( hwnd && (hwnd != GetHwnd()) )
|
|
|
|
hwnd = ::GetParent(hwnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return hwnd != NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::OnInternalIdle()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
// Check if we need to send a LEAVE event
|
|
|
|
if ( m_mouseInWindow )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// note that we should generate the leave event whether the window has
|
|
|
|
// or doesn't have mouse capture
|
|
|
|
if ( !IsMouseInWindow() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
GenerateMouseLeave();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // !HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (wxUpdateUIEvent::CanUpdate(this) && IsShownOnScreen())
|
|
|
|
UpdateWindowUI(wxUPDATE_UI_FROMIDLE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Set this window to be the child of 'parent'.
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::Reparent(wxWindowBase *parent)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !wxWindowBase::Reparent(parent) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWndChild = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
HWND hWndParent = GetParent() ? GetWinHwnd(GetParent()) : (HWND)0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetParent(hWndChild, hWndParent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( ::GetWindowLong(hWndChild, GWL_EXSTYLE) & WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
EnsureParentHasControlParentStyle(GetParent());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static inline void SendSetRedraw(HWND hwnd, bool on)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(hwnd, WM_SETREDRAW, (WPARAM)on, 0);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Freeze()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_frozenness++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( IsShown() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// If this is a TLW, then freeze it's non-TLW children
|
|
|
|
// instead. This is needed because on Windows a frozen TLW
|
|
|
|
// lets window paint and mouse events pass through to other
|
|
|
|
// Windows below this one in z-order.
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *child = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( child->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
child->Freeze();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // This is not a TLW, so just freeze it.
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SendSetRedraw(GetHwnd(), false);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Thaw()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( m_frozenness > 0, _T("Thaw() without matching Freeze()") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( --m_frozenness == 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( IsShown() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// If this is a TLW, then Thaw it's non-TLW children
|
|
|
|
// instead. See Freeze.
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *child = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( child->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// in case the child was added while the TLW was
|
|
|
|
// frozen, it won't be frozen now so avoid the Thaw.
|
|
|
|
if ( child->IsFrozen() )
|
|
|
|
child->Thaw();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // This is not a TLW, so just thaw it.
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SendSetRedraw(GetHwnd(), true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we need to refresh everything or otherwise the invalidated area
|
|
|
|
// is not going to be repainted
|
|
|
|
Refresh();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Refresh(bool eraseBack, const wxRect *rect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT mswRect;
|
|
|
|
const RECT *pRect;
|
|
|
|
if ( rect )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
mswRect.left = rect->x;
|
|
|
|
mswRect.top = rect->y;
|
|
|
|
mswRect.right = rect->x + rect->width;
|
|
|
|
mswRect.bottom = rect->y + rect->height;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pRect = &mswRect;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
pRect = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// RedrawWindow not available on SmartPhone or eVC++ 3
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__SMARTPHONE__) && !(defined(_WIN32_WCE) && _WIN32_WCE < 400)
|
|
|
|
UINT flags = RDW_INVALIDATE | RDW_ALLCHILDREN;
|
|
|
|
if ( eraseBack )
|
|
|
|
flags |= RDW_ERASE;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::RedrawWindow(hWnd, pRect, NULL, flags);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
::InvalidateRect(hWnd, pRect, eraseBack);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::Update()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::UpdateWindow(GetHwnd()) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("UpdateWindow"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXMICROWIN__) && !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
// just calling UpdateWindow() is not enough, what we did in our WM_PAINT
|
|
|
|
// handler needs to be really drawn right now
|
|
|
|
(void)::GdiFlush();
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WIN32__
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// drag and drop
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP || !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_STATBOX
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we need to lower the sibling static boxes so controls contained within can be
|
|
|
|
// a drop target
|
|
|
|
static void AdjustStaticBoxZOrder(wxWindow *parent)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// no sibling static boxes if we have no parent (ie TLW)
|
|
|
|
if ( !parent )
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = parent->GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxStaticBox *statbox = wxDynamicCast(node->GetData(), wxStaticBox);
|
|
|
|
if ( statbox )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowPos(GetHwndOf(statbox), HWND_BOTTOM, 0, 0, 0, 0,
|
|
|
|
SWP_NOMOVE | SWP_NOSIZE | SWP_NOACTIVATE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#else // !wxUSE_STATBOX
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static inline void AdjustStaticBoxZOrder(wxWindow * WXUNUSED(parent))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_STATBOX/!wxUSE_STATBOX
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // drag and drop is used
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetDropTarget(wxDropTarget *pDropTarget)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( m_dropTarget != 0 ) {
|
|
|
|
m_dropTarget->Revoke(m_hWnd);
|
|
|
|
delete m_dropTarget;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_dropTarget = pDropTarget;
|
|
|
|
if ( m_dropTarget != 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
AdjustStaticBoxZOrder(GetParent());
|
|
|
|
m_dropTarget->Register(m_hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// old-style file manager drag&drop support: we retain the old-style
|
|
|
|
// DragAcceptFiles in parallel with SetDropTarget.
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DragAcceptFiles(bool WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(accept))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
AdjustStaticBoxZOrder(GetParent());
|
|
|
|
::DragAcceptFiles(hWnd, (BOOL)accept);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// tooltips
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoSetToolTip(wxToolTip *tooltip)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::DoSetToolTip(tooltip);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( m_tooltip )
|
|
|
|
m_tooltip->SetWindow((wxWindow *)this);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// moving and resizing
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::IsSizeDeferred() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
if ( m_pendingPosition != wxDefaultPosition ||
|
|
|
|
m_pendingSize != wxDefaultSize )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Get total size
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoGetSize(int *x, int *y) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
// if SetSize() had been called at wx level but not realized at Windows
|
|
|
|
// level yet (i.e. EndDeferWindowPos() not called), we still should return
|
|
|
|
// the new and not the old position to the other wx code
|
|
|
|
if ( m_pendingSize != wxDefaultSize )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = m_pendingSize.x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = m_pendingSize.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // use current size
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT rect = wxGetWindowRect(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = rect.right - rect.left;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = rect.bottom - rect.top;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Get size *available for subwindows* i.e. excluding menu bar etc.
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoGetClientSize(int *x, int *y) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
if ( m_pendingSize != wxDefaultSize )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we need to calculate the client size corresponding to pending size
|
|
|
|
RECT rect;
|
|
|
|
rect.left = m_pendingPosition.x;
|
|
|
|
rect.top = m_pendingPosition.y;
|
|
|
|
rect.right = rect.left + m_pendingSize.x;
|
|
|
|
rect.bottom = rect.top + m_pendingSize.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(GetHwnd(), WM_NCCALCSIZE, FALSE, (LPARAM)&rect);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = rect.right - rect.left;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = rect.bottom - rect.top;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT rect = wxGetClientRect(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = rect.right;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = rect.bottom;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoGetPosition(int *x, int *y) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow * const parent = GetParent();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPoint pos;
|
|
|
|
if ( m_pendingPosition != wxDefaultPosition )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
pos = m_pendingPosition;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // use current position
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT rect = wxGetWindowRect(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
POINT point;
|
|
|
|
point.x = rect.left;
|
|
|
|
point.y = rect.top;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we do the adjustments with respect to the parent only for the "real"
|
|
|
|
// children, not for the dialogs/frames
|
|
|
|
if ( !IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( wxTheApp->GetLayoutDirection() == wxLayout_RightToLeft )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// In RTL mode, we want the logical left x-coordinate,
|
|
|
|
// which would be the physical right x-coordinate.
|
|
|
|
point.x = rect.right;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Since we now have the absolute screen coords, if there's a
|
|
|
|
// parent we must subtract its top left corner
|
|
|
|
if ( parent )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::ScreenToClient(GetHwndOf(parent), &point);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pos.x = point.x;
|
|
|
|
pos.y = point.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we also must adjust by the client area offset: a control which is just
|
|
|
|
// under a toolbar could be at (0, 30) in Windows but at (0, 0) in wx
|
|
|
|
if ( parent && !IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const wxPoint pt(parent->GetClientAreaOrigin());
|
|
|
|
pos.x -= pt.x;
|
|
|
|
pos.y -= pt.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = pos.x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = pos.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoScreenToClient(int *x, int *y) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
pt.x = *x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
pt.y = *y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::ScreenToClient(GetHwnd(), &pt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = pt.x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = pt.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoClientToScreen(int *x, int *y) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
pt.x = *x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
pt.y = *y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::ClientToScreen(GetHwnd(), &pt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = pt.x;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = pt.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::DoMoveSibling(WXHWND hwnd, int x, int y, int width, int height)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
// if our parent had prepared a defer window handle for us, use it (unless
|
|
|
|
// we are a top level window)
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW * const parent = IsTopLevel() ? NULL : GetParent();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HDWP hdwp = parent ? (HDWP)parent->m_hDWP : NULL;
|
|
|
|
if ( hdwp )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hdwp = ::DeferWindowPos(hdwp, (HWND)hwnd, NULL, x, y, width, height,
|
|
|
|
SWP_NOZORDER | SWP_NOOWNERZORDER | SWP_NOACTIVATE);
|
|
|
|
if ( !hdwp )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("DeferWindowPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( parent )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// hdwp must be updated as it may have been changed
|
|
|
|
parent->m_hDWP = (WXHANDLE)hdwp;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( hdwp )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// did deferred move, remember new coordinates of the window as they're
|
|
|
|
// different from what Windows would return for it
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// otherwise (or if deferring failed) move the window in place immediately
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
if ( !::MoveWindow((HWND)hwnd, x, y, width, height, IsShown()) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("MoveWindow"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING, indicates that we didn't use deferred move,
|
|
|
|
// ignored otherwise
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoMoveWindow(int x, int y, int width, int height)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// TODO: is this consistent with other platforms?
|
|
|
|
// Still, negative width or height shouldn't be allowed
|
|
|
|
if (width < 0)
|
|
|
|
width = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (height < 0)
|
|
|
|
height = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( DoMoveSibling(m_hWnd, x, y, width, height) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
m_pendingPosition = wxPoint(x, y);
|
|
|
|
m_pendingSize = wxSize(width, height);
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// set the size of the window: if the dimensions are positive, just use them,
|
|
|
|
// but if any of them is equal to -1, it means that we must find the value for
|
|
|
|
// it ourselves (unless sizeFlags contains wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE flag, in
|
|
|
|
// which case -1 is a valid value for x and y)
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// If sizeFlags contains wxSIZE_AUTO_WIDTH/HEIGHT flags (default), we calculate
|
|
|
|
// the width/height to best suit our contents, otherwise we reuse the current
|
|
|
|
// width/height
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoSetSize(int x, int y, int width, int height, int sizeFlags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// get the current size and position...
|
|
|
|
int currentX, currentY;
|
|
|
|
int currentW, currentH;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GetPosition(¤tX, ¤tY);
|
|
|
|
GetSize(¤tW, ¤tH);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ... and don't do anything (avoiding flicker) if it's already ok unless
|
|
|
|
// we're forced to resize the window
|
|
|
|
if ( x == currentX && y == currentY &&
|
|
|
|
width == currentW && height == currentH &&
|
|
|
|
!(sizeFlags & wxSIZE_FORCE) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x == wxDefaultCoord && !(sizeFlags & wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE) )
|
|
|
|
x = currentX;
|
|
|
|
if ( y == wxDefaultCoord && !(sizeFlags & wxSIZE_ALLOW_MINUS_ONE) )
|
|
|
|
y = currentY;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
AdjustForParentClientOrigin(x, y, sizeFlags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxSize size = wxDefaultSize;
|
|
|
|
if ( width == wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( sizeFlags & wxSIZE_AUTO_WIDTH )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
size = DoGetBestSize();
|
|
|
|
width = size.x;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// just take the current one
|
|
|
|
width = currentW;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( height == wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( sizeFlags & wxSIZE_AUTO_HEIGHT )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( size.x == wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
size = DoGetBestSize();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//else: already called DoGetBestSize() above
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
height = size.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// just take the current one
|
|
|
|
height = currentH;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
DoMoveWindow(x, y, width, height);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::DoSetClientSize(int width, int height)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// setting the client size is less obvious than it could have been
|
|
|
|
// because in the result of changing the total size the window scrollbar
|
|
|
|
// may [dis]appear and/or its menubar may [un]wrap (and AdjustWindowRect()
|
|
|
|
// doesn't take neither into account) and so the client size will not be
|
|
|
|
// correct as the difference between the total and client size changes --
|
|
|
|
// so we keep changing it until we get it right
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// normally this loop shouldn't take more than 3 iterations (usually 1 but
|
|
|
|
// if scrollbars [dis]appear as the result of the first call, then 2 and it
|
|
|
|
// may become 3 if the window had 0 size originally and so we didn't
|
|
|
|
// calculate the scrollbar correction correctly during the first iteration)
|
|
|
|
// but just to be on the safe side we check for it instead of making it an
|
|
|
|
// "infinite" loop (i.e. leaving break inside as the only way to get out)
|
|
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < 4; i++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
RECT rectClient;
|
|
|
|
::GetClientRect(GetHwnd(), &rectClient);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if the size is already ok, stop here (NB: rectClient.left = top = 0)
|
|
|
|
if ( (rectClient.right == width || width == wxDefaultCoord) &&
|
|
|
|
(rectClient.bottom == height || height == wxDefaultCoord) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Find the difference between the entire window (title bar and all)
|
|
|
|
// and the client area; add this to the new client size to move the
|
|
|
|
// window
|
|
|
|
RECT rectWin;
|
|
|
|
::GetWindowRect(GetHwnd(), &rectWin);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const int widthWin = rectWin.right - rectWin.left,
|
|
|
|
heightWin = rectWin.bottom - rectWin.top;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// MoveWindow positions the child windows relative to the parent, so
|
|
|
|
// adjust if necessary
|
|
|
|
if ( !IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *parent = GetParent();
|
|
|
|
if ( parent )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::ScreenToClient(GetHwndOf(parent), (POINT *)&rectWin);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't call DoMoveWindow() because we want to move window immediately
|
|
|
|
// and not defer it here as otherwise the value returned by
|
|
|
|
// GetClient/WindowRect() wouldn't change as the window wouldn't be
|
|
|
|
// really resized
|
|
|
|
if ( !::MoveWindow(GetHwnd(),
|
|
|
|
rectWin.left,
|
|
|
|
rectWin.top,
|
|
|
|
width + widthWin - rectClient.right,
|
|
|
|
height + heightWin - rectClient.bottom,
|
|
|
|
TRUE) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("MoveWindow"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// text metrics
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::GetCharHeight() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return wxGetTextMetrics(this).tmHeight;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::GetCharWidth() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// +1 is needed because Windows apparently adds it when calculating the
|
|
|
|
// dialog units size in pixels
|
|
|
|
#if wxDIALOG_UNIT_COMPATIBILITY
|
|
|
|
return wxGetTextMetrics(this).tmAveCharWidth;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
return wxGetTextMetrics(this).tmAveCharWidth + 1;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::GetTextExtent(const wxString& string,
|
|
|
|
int *x, int *y,
|
|
|
|
int *descent, int *externalLeading,
|
|
|
|
const wxFont *theFont) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( !theFont || theFont->Ok(),
|
|
|
|
_T("invalid font in GetTextExtent()") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxFont fontToUse;
|
|
|
|
if (theFont)
|
|
|
|
fontToUse = *theFont;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
fontToUse = GetFont();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WindowHDC hdc(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
SelectInHDC selectFont(hdc, GetHfontOf(fontToUse));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SIZE sizeRect;
|
|
|
|
TEXTMETRIC tm;
|
|
|
|
::GetTextExtentPoint32(hdc, string, string.length(), &sizeRect);
|
|
|
|
GetTextMetrics(hdc, &tm);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = sizeRect.cx;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = sizeRect.cy;
|
|
|
|
if ( descent )
|
|
|
|
*descent = tm.tmDescent;
|
|
|
|
if ( externalLeading )
|
|
|
|
*externalLeading = tm.tmExternalLeading;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// popup menu
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// yield for WM_COMMAND events only, i.e. process all WM_COMMANDs in the queue
|
|
|
|
// immediately, without waiting for the next event loop iteration
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// NB: this function should probably be made public later as it can almost
|
|
|
|
// surely replace wxYield() elsewhere as well
|
|
|
|
static void wxYieldForCommandsOnly()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// peek all WM_COMMANDs (it will always return WM_QUIT too but we don't
|
|
|
|
// want to process it here)
|
|
|
|
MSG msg;
|
|
|
|
while ( ::PeekMessage(&msg, (HWND)0, WM_COMMAND, WM_COMMAND, PM_REMOVE) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( msg.message == WM_QUIT )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// if we retrieved a WM_QUIT, insert back into the message queue.
|
|
|
|
::PostQuitMessage(0);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// luckily (as we don't have access to wxEventLoopImpl method from here
|
|
|
|
// anyhow...) we don't need to pre process WM_COMMANDs so dispatch it
|
|
|
|
// immediately
|
|
|
|
::TranslateMessage(&msg);
|
|
|
|
::DispatchMessage(&msg);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::DoPopupMenu(wxMenu *menu, int x, int y)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
menu->SetInvokingWindow(this);
|
|
|
|
menu->UpdateUI();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x == wxDefaultCoord && y == wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxPoint mouse = ScreenToClient(wxGetMousePosition());
|
|
|
|
x = mouse.x; y = mouse.y;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
HMENU hMenu = GetHmenuOf(menu);
|
|
|
|
POINT point;
|
|
|
|
point.x = x;
|
|
|
|
point.y = y;
|
|
|
|
::ClientToScreen(hWnd, &point);
|
|
|
|
wxCurrentPopupMenu = menu;
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
static const UINT flags = 0;
|
|
|
|
#else // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
UINT flags = TPM_RIGHTBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
// NT4 doesn't support TPM_RECURSE and simply doesn't show the menu at all
|
|
|
|
// when it's use, I'm not sure about Win95/98 but prefer to err on the safe
|
|
|
|
// side and not to use it there neither -- modify the test if it does work
|
|
|
|
// on these systems
|
|
|
|
if ( wxGetWinVersion() >= wxWinVersion_5 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// using TPM_RECURSE allows us to show a popup menu while another menu
|
|
|
|
// is opened which can be useful and is supported by the other
|
|
|
|
// platforms, so allow it under Windows too
|
|
|
|
flags |= TPM_RECURSE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__/!__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::TrackPopupMenu(hMenu, flags, point.x, point.y, 0, hWnd, NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we need to do it right now as otherwise the events are never going to be
|
|
|
|
// sent to wxCurrentPopupMenu from HandleCommand()
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// note that even eliminating (ugly) wxCurrentPopupMenu global wouldn't
|
|
|
|
// help and we'd still need wxYieldForCommandsOnly() as the menu may be
|
|
|
|
// destroyed as soon as we return (it can be a local variable in the caller
|
|
|
|
// for example) and so we do need to process the event immediately
|
|
|
|
wxYieldForCommandsOnly();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCurrentPopupMenu = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
menu->SetInvokingWindow(NULL);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
// pre/post message processing
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXLRESULT wxWindowMSW::MSWDefWindowProc(WXUINT nMsg, WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( m_oldWndProc )
|
|
|
|
return ::CallWindowProc(CASTWNDPROC m_oldWndProc, GetHwnd(), (UINT) nMsg, (WPARAM) wParam, (LPARAM) lParam);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
return ::DefWindowProc(GetHwnd(), nMsg, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWProcessMessage(WXMSG* pMsg)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// wxUniversal implements tab traversal itself
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
if ( m_hWnd != 0 && (GetWindowStyleFlag() & wxTAB_TRAVERSAL) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// intercept dialog navigation keys
|
|
|
|
MSG *msg = (MSG *)pMsg;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// here we try to do all the job which ::IsDialogMessage() usually does
|
|
|
|
// internally
|
|
|
|
if ( msg->message == WM_KEYDOWN )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool bCtrlDown = wxIsCtrlDown();
|
|
|
|
bool bShiftDown = wxIsShiftDown();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// WM_GETDLGCODE: ask the control if it wants the key for itself,
|
|
|
|
// don't process it if it's the case (except for Ctrl-Tab/Enter
|
|
|
|
// combinations which are always processed)
|
|
|
|
LONG lDlgCode = ::SendMessage(msg->hwnd, WM_GETDLGCODE, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// surprizingly, DLGC_WANTALLKEYS bit mask doesn't contain the
|
|
|
|
// DLGC_WANTTAB nor DLGC_WANTARROWS bits although, logically,
|
|
|
|
// it, of course, implies them
|
|
|
|
if ( lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTALLKEYS )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
lDlgCode |= DLGC_WANTTAB | DLGC_WANTARROWS;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool bForward = true,
|
|
|
|
bWindowChange = false,
|
|
|
|
bFromTab = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// should we process this message specially?
|
|
|
|
bool bProcess = true;
|
|
|
|
switch ( msg->wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case VK_TAB:
|
|
|
|
if ( (lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTTAB) && !bCtrlDown )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// let the control have the TAB
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // use it for navigation
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Ctrl-Tab cycles thru notebook pages
|
|
|
|
bWindowChange = bCtrlDown;
|
|
|
|
bForward = !bShiftDown;
|
|
|
|
bFromTab = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_UP:
|
|
|
|
case VK_LEFT:
|
|
|
|
if ( (lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTARROWS) || bCtrlDown )
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
bForward = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_DOWN:
|
|
|
|
case VK_RIGHT:
|
|
|
|
if ( (lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTARROWS) || bCtrlDown )
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_PRIOR:
|
|
|
|
bForward = false;
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_NEXT:
|
|
|
|
// we treat PageUp/Dn as arrows because chances are that
|
|
|
|
// a control which needs arrows also needs them for
|
|
|
|
// navigation (e.g. wxTextCtrl, wxListCtrl, ...)
|
|
|
|
if ( (lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTARROWS) && !bCtrlDown )
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
else // OTOH Ctrl-PageUp/Dn works as [Shift-]Ctrl-Tab
|
|
|
|
bWindowChange = true;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_RETURN:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( (lDlgCode & DLGC_WANTMESSAGE) && !bCtrlDown )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// control wants to process Enter itself, don't
|
|
|
|
// call IsDialogMessage() which would consume it
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_BUTTON
|
|
|
|
// currently active button should get enter press even
|
|
|
|
// if there is a default button elsewhere so check if
|
|
|
|
// this window is a button first
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *btn = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if ( lDlgCode & DLGC_DEFPUSHBUTTON )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// let IsDialogMessage() handle this for all
|
|
|
|
// buttons except the owner-drawn ones which it
|
|
|
|
// just seems to ignore
|
|
|
|
long style = ::GetWindowLong(msg->hwnd, GWL_STYLE);
|
|
|
|
if ( (style & BS_OWNERDRAW) == BS_OWNERDRAW )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// emulate the button click
|
|
|
|
btn = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)msg->hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // not a button itself, do we have default button?
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxTopLevelWindow *
|
|
|
|
tlw = wxDynamicCast(wxGetTopLevelParent(this),
|
|
|
|
wxTopLevelWindow);
|
|
|
|
if ( tlw )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
btn = wxDynamicCast(tlw->GetDefaultItem(),
|
|
|
|
wxButton);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( btn && btn->IsEnabled() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
btn->MSWCommand(BN_CLICKED, 0 /* unused */);
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_BUTTON
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// map Enter presses into button presses on PDAs
|
|
|
|
wxJoystickEvent event(wxEVT_JOY_BUTTON_DOWN);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
if ( GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event) )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
bProcess = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( bProcess )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxNavigationKeyEvent event;
|
|
|
|
event.SetDirection(bForward);
|
|
|
|
event.SetWindowChange(bWindowChange);
|
|
|
|
event.SetFromTab(bFromTab);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// as we don't call IsDialogMessage(), which would take of
|
|
|
|
// this by default, we need to manually send this message
|
|
|
|
// so that controls can change their UI state if needed
|
|
|
|
MSWUpdateUIState(UIS_CLEAR, UISF_HIDEFOCUS);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( ::IsDialogMessage(GetHwnd(), msg) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// IsDialogMessage() did something...
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
if ( m_tooltip )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// relay mouse move events to the tooltip control
|
|
|
|
MSG *msg = (MSG *)pMsg;
|
|
|
|
if ( msg->message == WM_MOUSEMOVE )
|
|
|
|
wxToolTip::RelayEvent(pMsg);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWTranslateMessage(WXMSG* pMsg)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_ACCEL && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
return m_acceleratorTable.Translate(this, pMsg);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
(void) pMsg;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_ACCEL
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWShouldPreProcessMessage(WXMSG* msg)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// all tests below have to deal with various bugs/misfeatures of
|
|
|
|
// IsDialogMessage(): we have to prevent it from being called from our
|
|
|
|
// MSWProcessMessage() in some situations
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't let IsDialogMessage() get VK_ESCAPE as it _always_ eats the
|
|
|
|
// message even when there is no cancel button and when the message is
|
|
|
|
// needed by the control itself: in particular, it prevents the tree in
|
|
|
|
// place edit control from being closed with Escape in a dialog
|
|
|
|
if ( msg->message == WM_KEYDOWN && msg->wParam == VK_ESCAPE )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ::IsDialogMessage() is broken and may sometimes hang the application by
|
|
|
|
// going into an infinite loop when it tries to find the control to give
|
|
|
|
// focus to when Alt-<key> is pressed, so we try to detect [some of] the
|
|
|
|
// situations when this may happen and not call it then
|
|
|
|
if ( msg->message != WM_SYSCHAR )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// assume we can call it by default
|
|
|
|
bool canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hwndFocus = ::GetFocus();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if the currently focused window itself has WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT style,
|
|
|
|
// ::IsDialogMessage() will also enter an infinite loop, because it will
|
|
|
|
// recursively check the child windows but not the window itself and so if
|
|
|
|
// none of the children accepts focus it loops forever (as it only stops
|
|
|
|
// when it gets back to the window it started from)
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// while it is very unusual that a window with WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT
|
|
|
|
// style has the focus, it can happen. One such possibility is if
|
|
|
|
// all windows are either toplevel, wxDialog, wxPanel or static
|
|
|
|
// controls and no window can actually accept keyboard input.
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
if ( ::GetWindowLong(hwndFocus, GWL_EXSTYLE) & WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// pessimistic by default
|
|
|
|
canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg = false;
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow * const win = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( win->AcceptsFocus() &&
|
|
|
|
!(::GetWindowLong(GetHwndOf(win), GWL_EXSTYLE) &
|
|
|
|
WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it shouldn't hang...
|
|
|
|
canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// ::IsDialogMessage() can enter in an infinite loop when the
|
|
|
|
// currently focused window is disabled or hidden and its
|
|
|
|
// parent has WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT style, so don't call it in
|
|
|
|
// this case
|
|
|
|
while ( hwndFocus )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::IsWindowEnabled(hwndFocus) ||
|
|
|
|
!::IsWindowVisible(hwndFocus) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it would enter an infinite loop if we do this!
|
|
|
|
canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !(::GetWindowLong(hwndFocus, GWL_STYLE) & WS_CHILD) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it's a top level window, don't go further -- e.g. even
|
|
|
|
// if the parent of a dialog is disabled, this doesn't
|
|
|
|
// break navigation inside the dialog
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
hwndFocus = ::GetParent(hwndFocus);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return canSafelyCallIsDlgMsg;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// message params unpackers
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnpackCommand(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WORD *id, WXHWND *hwnd, WORD *cmd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*id = LOWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*hwnd = (WXHWND)lParam;
|
|
|
|
*cmd = HIWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnpackActivate(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXWORD *state, WXWORD *minimized, WXHWND *hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*state = LOWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*minimized = HIWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*hwnd = (WXHWND)lParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnpackScroll(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXWORD *code, WXWORD *pos, WXHWND *hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*code = LOWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*pos = HIWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*hwnd = (WXHWND)lParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnpackCtlColor(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXHDC *hdc, WXHWND *hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*hwnd = (WXHWND)lParam;
|
|
|
|
*hdc = (WXHDC)wParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::UnpackMenuSelect(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXWORD *item, WXWORD *flags, WXHMENU *hmenu)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
*item = (WXWORD)wParam;
|
|
|
|
*flags = HIWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
*hmenu = (WXHMENU)lParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// Main wxWidgets window proc and the window proc for wxWindow
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Hook for new window just as it's being created, when the window isn't yet
|
|
|
|
// associated with the handle
|
|
|
|
static wxWindowMSW *gs_winBeingCreated = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// implementation of wxWindowCreationHook class: it just sets gs_winBeingCreated to the
|
|
|
|
// window being created and insures that it's always unset back later
|
|
|
|
wxWindowCreationHook::wxWindowCreationHook(wxWindowMSW *winBeingCreated)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
gs_winBeingCreated = winBeingCreated;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowCreationHook::~wxWindowCreationHook()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
gs_winBeingCreated = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Main window proc
|
|
|
|
LRESULT WXDLLEXPORT APIENTRY _EXPORT wxWndProc(HWND hWnd, UINT message, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// trace all messages - useful for the debugging
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
wxLogTrace(wxTraceMessages,
|
|
|
|
wxT("Processing %s(hWnd=%08lx, wParam=%8lx, lParam=%8lx)"),
|
|
|
|
wxGetMessageName(message), (long)hWnd, (long)wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *wnd = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND) hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// when we get the first message for the HWND we just created, we associate
|
|
|
|
// it with wxWindow stored in gs_winBeingCreated
|
|
|
|
if ( !wnd && gs_winBeingCreated )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxAssociateWinWithHandle(hWnd, gs_winBeingCreated);
|
|
|
|
wnd = gs_winBeingCreated;
|
|
|
|
gs_winBeingCreated = NULL;
|
|
|
|
wnd->SetHWND((WXHWND)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LRESULT rc;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( wnd && wxEventLoop::AllowProcessing(wnd) )
|
|
|
|
rc = wnd->MSWWindowProc(message, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
rc = ::DefWindowProc(hWnd, message, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXLRESULT wxWindowMSW::MSWWindowProc(WXUINT message, WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// did we process the message?
|
|
|
|
bool processed = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the return value
|
|
|
|
union
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool allow;
|
|
|
|
WXLRESULT result;
|
|
|
|
WXHBRUSH hBrush;
|
|
|
|
} rc;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// for most messages we should return 0 when we do process the message
|
|
|
|
rc.result = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch ( message )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case WM_CREATE:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool mayCreate;
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleCreate((WXLPCREATESTRUCT)lParam, &mayCreate);
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// return 0 to allow window creation
|
|
|
|
rc.result = mayCreate ? 0 : -1;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_DESTROY:
|
|
|
|
// never set processed to true and *always* pass WM_DESTROY to
|
|
|
|
// DefWindowProc() as Windows may do some internal cleanup when
|
|
|
|
// processing it and failing to pass the message along may cause
|
|
|
|
// memory and resource leaks!
|
|
|
|
(void)HandleDestroy();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SIZE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSize(LOWORD(lParam), HIWORD(lParam), wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_MOVE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMove(GET_X_LPARAM(lParam), GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam));
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_MOVING:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
LPRECT pRect = (LPRECT)lParam;
|
|
|
|
wxRect rc;
|
|
|
|
rc.SetLeft(pRect->left);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetTop(pRect->top);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetRight(pRect->right);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetBottom(pRect->bottom);
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMoving(rc);
|
|
|
|
if (processed) {
|
|
|
|
pRect->left = rc.GetLeft();
|
|
|
|
pRect->top = rc.GetTop();
|
|
|
|
pRect->right = rc.GetRight();
|
|
|
|
pRect->bottom = rc.GetBottom();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SIZING:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
LPRECT pRect = (LPRECT)lParam;
|
|
|
|
wxRect rc;
|
|
|
|
rc.SetLeft(pRect->left);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetTop(pRect->top);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetRight(pRect->right);
|
|
|
|
rc.SetBottom(pRect->bottom);
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSizing(rc);
|
|
|
|
if (processed) {
|
|
|
|
pRect->left = rc.GetLeft();
|
|
|
|
pRect->top = rc.GetTop();
|
|
|
|
pRect->right = rc.GetRight();
|
|
|
|
pRect->bottom = rc.GetBottom();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXMICROWIN__) && !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_ACTIVATEAPP:
|
|
|
|
// This implicitly sends a wxEVT_ACTIVATE_APP event
|
|
|
|
wxTheApp->SetActive(wParam != 0, FindFocus());
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_ACTIVATE:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WXWORD state, minimized;
|
|
|
|
WXHWND hwnd;
|
|
|
|
UnpackActivate(wParam, lParam, &state, &minimized, &hwnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleActivate(state, minimized != 0, (WXHWND)hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SETFOCUS:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSetFocus((WXHWND)(HWND)wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_KILLFOCUS:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleKillFocus((WXHWND)(HWND)wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_PRINTCLIENT:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandlePrintClient((WXHDC)wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_PAINT:
|
|
|
|
if ( wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxPaintDCEx dc((wxWindow *)this, (WXHDC)wParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = HandlePaint();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // no DC given
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = HandlePaint();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_CLOSE:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
// Universal uses its own wxFrame/wxDialog, so we don't receive
|
|
|
|
// close events unless we have this.
|
|
|
|
Close();
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't let the DefWindowProc() destroy our window - we'll do it
|
|
|
|
// ourselves in ~wxWindow
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
rc.result = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SHOWWINDOW:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleShow(wParam != 0, (int)lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_MOUSEMOVE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMouseMove(GET_X_LPARAM(lParam),
|
|
|
|
GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam),
|
|
|
|
wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
case WM_MOUSELEAVE:
|
|
|
|
// filter out excess WM_MOUSELEAVE events sent after PopupMenu()
|
|
|
|
// (on XP at least)
|
|
|
|
if ( m_mouseInWindow )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
GenerateMouseLeave();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// always pass processed back as false, this allows the window
|
|
|
|
// manager to process the message too. This is needed to
|
|
|
|
// ensure windows XP themes work properly as the mouse moves
|
|
|
|
// over widgets like buttons. So don't set processed to true here.
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MOUSEWHEEL
|
|
|
|
case WM_MOUSEWHEEL:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMouseWheel(wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_LBUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WM_LBUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
case WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK:
|
|
|
|
case WM_RBUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WM_RBUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
case WM_RBUTTONDBLCLK:
|
|
|
|
case WM_MBUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WM_MBUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
case WM_MBUTTONDBLCLK:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
// MicroWindows seems to ignore the fact that a window is
|
|
|
|
// disabled. So catch mouse events and throw them away if
|
|
|
|
// necessary.
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW* win = this;
|
|
|
|
for ( ;; )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!win->IsEnabled())
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
win = win->GetParent();
|
|
|
|
if ( !win || win->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
int x = GET_X_LPARAM(lParam),
|
|
|
|
y = GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// redirect the event to a static control if necessary by
|
|
|
|
// finding one under mouse because under CE the static controls
|
|
|
|
// don't generate mouse events (even with SS_NOTIFY)
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *win;
|
|
|
|
if ( GetCapture() == this )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// but don't do it if the mouse is captured by this window
|
|
|
|
// because then it should really get this event itself
|
|
|
|
win = this;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = FindWindowForMouseEvent(this, &x, &y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// this should never happen
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( win, 0,
|
|
|
|
_T("FindWindowForMouseEvent() returned NULL") );
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __POCKETPC__
|
|
|
|
if (IsContextMenuEnabled() && message == WM_LBUTTONDOWN)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SHRGINFO shrgi = {0};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
shrgi.cbSize = sizeof(SHRGINFO);
|
|
|
|
shrgi.hwndClient = (HWND) GetHWND();
|
|
|
|
shrgi.ptDown.x = x;
|
|
|
|
shrgi.ptDown.y = y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
shrgi.dwFlags = SHRG_RETURNCMD;
|
|
|
|
// shrgi.dwFlags = SHRG_NOTIFYPARENT;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (GN_CONTEXTMENU == ::SHRecognizeGesture(&shrgi))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxPoint pt(x, y);
|
|
|
|
pt = ClientToScreen(pt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxContextMenuEvent evtCtx(wxEVT_CONTEXT_MENU, GetId(), pt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
evtCtx.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
if (GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(evtCtx))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#else // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *win = this;
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__/!__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = win->HandleMouseEvent(message, x, y, wParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if the app didn't eat the event, handle it in the default
|
|
|
|
// way, that is by giving this window the focus
|
|
|
|
if ( !processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// for the standard classes their WndProc sets the focus to
|
|
|
|
// them anyhow and doing it from here results in some weird
|
|
|
|
// problems, so don't do it for them (unnecessary anyhow)
|
|
|
|
if ( !win->IsOfStandardClass() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( message == WM_LBUTTONDOWN && win->AcceptsFocus() )
|
|
|
|
win->SetFocus();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef MM_JOY1MOVE
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1MOVE:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2MOVE:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1ZMOVE:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2ZMOVE:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1BUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2BUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1BUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2BUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleJoystickEvent(message,
|
|
|
|
GET_X_LPARAM(lParam),
|
|
|
|
GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam),
|
|
|
|
wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_COMMAND:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WORD id, cmd;
|
|
|
|
WXHWND hwnd;
|
|
|
|
UnpackCommand(wParam, lParam, &id, &hwnd, &cmd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleCommand(id, cmd, hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_NOTIFY:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleNotify((int)wParam, lParam, &rc.result);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we only need to reply to WM_NOTIFYFORMAT manually when using MSLU,
|
|
|
|
// otherwise DefWindowProc() does it perfectly fine for us, but MSLU
|
|
|
|
// apparently doesn't always behave properly and needs some help
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_UNICODE_MSLU && defined(NF_QUERY)
|
|
|
|
case WM_NOTIFYFORMAT:
|
|
|
|
if ( lParam == NF_QUERY )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
rc.result = NFR_UNICODE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_UNICODE_MSLU
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// for these messages we must return true if process the message
|
|
|
|
#ifdef WM_DRAWITEM
|
|
|
|
case WM_DRAWITEM:
|
|
|
|
case WM_MEASUREITEM:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int idCtrl = (UINT)wParam;
|
|
|
|
if ( message == WM_DRAWITEM )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = MSWOnDrawItem(idCtrl,
|
|
|
|
(WXDRAWITEMSTRUCT *)lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = MSWOnMeasureItem(idCtrl,
|
|
|
|
(WXMEASUREITEMSTRUCT *)lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
rc.result = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // defined(WM_DRAWITEM)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_GETDLGCODE:
|
|
|
|
if ( !IsOfStandardClass() || HasFlag(wxWANTS_CHARS) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we always want to get the char events
|
|
|
|
rc.result = DLGC_WANTCHARS;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( HasFlag(wxWANTS_CHARS) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// in fact, we want everything
|
|
|
|
rc.result |= DLGC_WANTARROWS |
|
|
|
|
DLGC_WANTTAB |
|
|
|
|
DLGC_WANTALLKEYS;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//else: get the dlg code from the DefWindowProc()
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SYSKEYDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WM_KEYDOWN:
|
|
|
|
// If this has been processed by an event handler, return 0 now
|
|
|
|
// (we've handled it).
|
|
|
|
m_lastKeydownProcessed = HandleKeyDown((WORD) wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( m_lastKeydownProcessed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
switch ( wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we consider these messages "not interesting" to OnChar, so
|
|
|
|
// just don't do anything more with them
|
|
|
|
case VK_SHIFT:
|
|
|
|
case VK_CONTROL:
|
|
|
|
case VK_MENU:
|
|
|
|
case VK_CAPITAL:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMLOCK:
|
|
|
|
case VK_SCROLL:
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// avoid duplicate messages to OnChar for these ASCII keys:
|
|
|
|
// they will be translated by TranslateMessage() and received
|
|
|
|
// in WM_CHAR
|
|
|
|
case VK_ESCAPE:
|
|
|
|
case VK_SPACE:
|
|
|
|
case VK_RETURN:
|
|
|
|
case VK_BACK:
|
|
|
|
case VK_TAB:
|
|
|
|
case VK_ADD:
|
|
|
|
case VK_SUBTRACT:
|
|
|
|
case VK_MULTIPLY:
|
|
|
|
case VK_DIVIDE:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD0:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD1:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD2:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD3:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD4:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD5:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD6:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD7:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD8:
|
|
|
|
case VK_NUMPAD9:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_1:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_2:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_3:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_4:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_5:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_6:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_7:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_PLUS:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_COMMA:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_MINUS:
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_PERIOD:
|
|
|
|
// but set processed to false, not true to still pass them
|
|
|
|
// to the control's default window proc - otherwise
|
|
|
|
// built-in keyboard handling won't work
|
|
|
|
processed = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef VK_APPS
|
|
|
|
// special case of VK_APPS: treat it the same as right mouse
|
|
|
|
// click because both usually pop up a context menu
|
|
|
|
case VK_APPS:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMouseEvent(WM_RBUTTONDOWN, -1, -1, 0);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // VK_APPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
// do generate a CHAR event
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleChar((WORD)wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (message == WM_SYSKEYDOWN) // Let Windows still handle the SYSKEYs
|
|
|
|
processed = false;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SYSKEYUP:
|
|
|
|
case WM_KEYUP:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef VK_APPS
|
|
|
|
// special case of VK_APPS: treat it the same as right mouse button
|
|
|
|
if ( wParam == VK_APPS )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMouseEvent(WM_RBUTTONUP, -1, -1, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif // VK_APPS
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleKeyUp((WORD) wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SYSCHAR:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CHAR: // Always an ASCII character
|
|
|
|
if ( m_lastKeydownProcessed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// The key was handled in the EVT_KEY_DOWN and handling
|
|
|
|
// a key in an EVT_KEY_DOWN handler is meant, by
|
|
|
|
// design, to prevent EVT_CHARs from happening
|
|
|
|
m_lastKeydownProcessed = false;
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleChar((WORD)wParam, lParam, true);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_HOTKEY
|
|
|
|
case WM_HOTKEY:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleHotKey((WORD)wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_HOTKEY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_HSCROLL:
|
|
|
|
case WM_VSCROLL:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WXWORD code, pos;
|
|
|
|
WXHWND hwnd;
|
|
|
|
UnpackScroll(wParam, lParam, &code, &pos, &hwnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = MSWOnScroll(message == WM_HSCROLL ? wxHORIZONTAL
|
|
|
|
: wxVERTICAL,
|
|
|
|
code, pos, hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// CTLCOLOR messages are sent by children to query the parent for their
|
|
|
|
// colors
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORMSGBOX:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLOREDIT:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORLISTBOX:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORBTN:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORDLG:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORSCROLLBAR:
|
|
|
|
case WM_CTLCOLORSTATIC:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WXHDC hdc;
|
|
|
|
WXHWND hwnd;
|
|
|
|
UnpackCtlColor(wParam, lParam, &hdc, &hwnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleCtlColor(&rc.hBrush, (WXHDC)hdc, (WXHWND)hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE:
|
|
|
|
// the return value for this message is ignored
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSysColorChange();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_DISPLAYCHANGE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleDisplayChange();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_PALETTECHANGED:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandlePaletteChanged((WXHWND) (HWND) wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_CAPTURECHANGED:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleCaptureChanged((WXHWND) (HWND) lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SETTINGCHANGE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSettingChange(wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleQueryNewPalette();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_ERASEBKGND:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleEraseBkgnd((WXHDC)(HDC)wParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we processed the message, i.e. erased the background
|
|
|
|
rc.result = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_DROPFILES:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleDropFiles(wParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_INITDIALOG:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleInitDialog((WXHWND)(HWND)wParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we never set focus from here
|
|
|
|
rc.result = FALSE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_QUERYENDSESSION:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleQueryEndSession(lParam, &rc.allow);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_ENDSESSION:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleEndSession(wParam != 0, lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_GETMINMAXINFO:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleGetMinMaxInfo((MINMAXINFO*)lParam);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_SETCURSOR:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleSetCursor((WXHWND)(HWND)wParam,
|
|
|
|
LOWORD(lParam), // hit test
|
|
|
|
HIWORD(lParam)); // mouse msg
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// returning TRUE stops the DefWindowProc() from further
|
|
|
|
// processing this message - exactly what we need because we've
|
|
|
|
// just set the cursor.
|
|
|
|
rc.result = TRUE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_ACCESSIBILITY
|
|
|
|
case WM_GETOBJECT:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
//WPARAM dwFlags = (WPARAM) (DWORD) wParam;
|
|
|
|
LPARAM dwObjId = (LPARAM) (DWORD) lParam;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (dwObjId == (LPARAM)OBJID_CLIENT && GetOrCreateAccessible())
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return LresultFromObject(IID_IAccessible, wParam, (IUnknown*) GetAccessible()->GetIAccessible());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(WM_HELP)
|
|
|
|
case WM_HELP:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// by default, WM_HELP is propagated by DefWindowProc() upwards
|
|
|
|
// to the window parent but as we do it ourselves already
|
|
|
|
// (wxHelpEvent is derived from wxCommandEvent), we don't want
|
|
|
|
// to get the other events if we process this message at all
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// WM_HELP doesn't use lParam under CE
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
HELPINFO* info = (HELPINFO*) lParam;
|
|
|
|
if ( info->iContextType == HELPINFO_WINDOW )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
wxHelpEvent helpEvent
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_HELP,
|
|
|
|
GetId(),
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
wxGetMousePosition() // what else?
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxPoint(info->MousePos.x, info->MousePos.y)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
helpEvent.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(helpEvent);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else if ( info->iContextType == HELPINFO_MENUITEM )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxHelpEvent helpEvent(wxEVT_HELP, info->iCtrlId);
|
|
|
|
helpEvent.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(helpEvent);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // unknown help event?
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
processed = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // WM_HELP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
case WM_CONTEXTMENU:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we don't convert from screen to client coordinates as
|
|
|
|
// the event may be handled by a parent window
|
|
|
|
wxPoint pt(GET_X_LPARAM(lParam), GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxContextMenuEvent evtCtx(wxEVT_CONTEXT_MENU, GetId(), pt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we could have got an event from our child, reflect it back
|
|
|
|
// to it if this is the case
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *win = NULL;
|
|
|
|
if ( (WXHWND)wParam != m_hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = FindItemByHWND((WXHWND)wParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !win )
|
|
|
|
win = this;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
evtCtx.SetEventObject(win);
|
|
|
|
processed = win->GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(evtCtx);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_MENUCHAR:
|
|
|
|
// we're only interested in our own menus, not MF_SYSMENU
|
|
|
|
if ( HIWORD(wParam) == MF_POPUP )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// handle menu chars for ownerdrawn menu items
|
|
|
|
int i = HandleMenuChar(toupper(LOWORD(wParam)), lParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( i != wxNOT_FOUND )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
rc.result = MAKELRESULT(i, MNC_EXECUTE);
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
case WM_POWERBROADCAST:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool vetoed;
|
|
|
|
processed = HandlePower(wParam, lParam, &vetoed);
|
|
|
|
rc.result = processed && vetoed ? BROADCAST_QUERY_DENY : TRUE;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_UXTHEME
|
|
|
|
// If we want the default themed border then we need to draw it ourselves
|
|
|
|
case WM_NCCALCSIZE:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxUxThemeEngine* theme = wxUxThemeEngine::GetIfActive();
|
|
|
|
if (theme && TranslateBorder(GetBorder()) == wxBORDER_THEME)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// first ask the widget to calculate the border size
|
|
|
|
rc.result = MSWDefWindowProc(message, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// now alter the client size making room for drawing a themed border
|
|
|
|
NCCALCSIZE_PARAMS *csparam = NULL;
|
|
|
|
RECT rect;
|
|
|
|
if (wParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
csparam = (NCCALCSIZE_PARAMS*)lParam;
|
|
|
|
rect = csparam->rgrc[0];
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
rect = *((RECT*)lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
wxUxThemeHandle hTheme((const wxWindow*) this, L"EDIT");
|
|
|
|
RECT rcClient = { 0, 0, 0, 0 };
|
|
|
|
wxClientDC dc((wxWindow*) this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (theme->GetThemeBackgroundContentRect(
|
|
|
|
hTheme, GetHdcOf(dc), EP_EDITTEXT, ETS_NORMAL,
|
|
|
|
&rect, &rcClient) == S_OK)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
InflateRect(&rcClient, -1, -1);
|
|
|
|
if (wParam)
|
|
|
|
csparam->rgrc[0] = rcClient;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
*((RECT*)lParam) = rcClient;
|
|
|
|
rc.result = WVR_REDRAW;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WM_NCPAINT:
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxUxThemeEngine* theme = wxUxThemeEngine::GetIfActive();
|
|
|
|
if (theme && TranslateBorder(GetBorder()) == wxBORDER_THEME)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// first ask the widget to paint its non-client area, such as scrollbars, etc.
|
|
|
|
rc.result = MSWDefWindowProc(message, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
processed = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxUxThemeHandle hTheme((const wxWindow*) this, L"EDIT");
|
|
|
|
wxWindowDC dc((wxWindow*) this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Clip the DC so that you only draw on the non-client area
|
|
|
|
RECT rcBorder;
|
|
|
|
wxCopyRectToRECT(GetSize(), rcBorder);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
RECT rcClient;
|
|
|
|
theme->GetThemeBackgroundContentRect(
|
|
|
|
hTheme, GetHdcOf(dc), EP_EDITTEXT, ETS_NORMAL, &rcBorder, &rcClient);
|
|
|
|
InflateRect(&rcClient, -1, -1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::ExcludeClipRect(GetHdcOf(dc), rcClient.left, rcClient.top,
|
|
|
|
rcClient.right, rcClient.bottom);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Make sure the background is in a proper state
|
|
|
|
if (theme->IsThemeBackgroundPartiallyTransparent(hTheme, EP_EDITTEXT, ETS_NORMAL))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
theme->DrawThemeParentBackground(GetHwnd(), GetHdcOf(dc), &rcBorder);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Draw the border
|
|
|
|
int nState;
|
|
|
|
if ( !IsEnabled() )
|
|
|
|
nState = ETS_DISABLED;
|
|
|
|
// should we check this?
|
|
|
|
//else if ( ::GetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_STYLE) & ES_READONLY)
|
|
|
|
// nState = ETS_READONLY;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
nState = ETS_NORMAL;
|
|
|
|
theme->DrawThemeBackground(hTheme, GetHdcOf(dc), EP_EDITTEXT, nState, &rcBorder, NULL);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_UXTHEME
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !processed )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
wxLogTrace(wxTraceMessages, wxT("Forwarding %s to DefWindowProc."),
|
|
|
|
wxGetMessageName(message));
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
rc.result = MSWDefWindowProc(message, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc.result;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// wxWindow <-> HWND map
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWinHashTable *wxWinHandleHash = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxFindWinFromHandle(WXHWND hWnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return (wxWindow*)wxWinHandleHash->Get((long)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxAssociateWinWithHandle(HWND hWnd, wxWindowMSW *win)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// adding NULL hWnd is (first) surely a result of an error and
|
|
|
|
// (secondly) breaks menu command processing
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_RET( hWnd != (HWND)NULL,
|
|
|
|
wxT("attempt to add a NULL hWnd to window list ignored") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *oldWin = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND) hWnd);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
if ( oldWin && (oldWin != win) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogDebug(wxT("HWND %X already associated with another window (%s)"),
|
|
|
|
(int) hWnd, win->GetClassInfo()->GetClassName());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
if (!oldWin)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWinHandleHash->Put((long)hWnd, (wxWindow *)win);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxRemoveHandleAssociation(wxWindowMSW *win)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWinHandleHash->Delete((long)win->GetHWND());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// various MSW speciic class dependent functions
|
|
|
|
// ----------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Default destroyer - override if you destroy it in some other way
|
|
|
|
// (e.g. with MDI child windows)
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::MSWDestroyWindow()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWGetCreateWindowCoords(const wxPoint& pos,
|
|
|
|
const wxSize& size,
|
|
|
|
int& x, int& y,
|
|
|
|
int& w, int& h) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// yes, those are just some arbitrary hardcoded numbers
|
|
|
|
static const int DEFAULT_Y = 200;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool nonDefault = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( pos.x == wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// if x is set to CW_USEDEFAULT, y parameter is ignored anyhow so we
|
|
|
|
// can just as well set it to CW_USEDEFAULT as well
|
|
|
|
x =
|
|
|
|
y = CW_USEDEFAULT;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// OTOH, if x is not set to CW_USEDEFAULT, y shouldn't be set to it
|
|
|
|
// neither because it is not handled as a special value by Windows then
|
|
|
|
// and so we have to choose some default value for it
|
|
|
|
x = pos.x;
|
|
|
|
y = pos.y == wxDefaultCoord ? DEFAULT_Y : pos.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
nonDefault = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/*
|
|
|
|
NB: there used to be some code here which set the initial size of the
|
|
|
|
window to the client size of the parent if no explicit size was
|
|
|
|
specified. This was wrong because wxWidgets programs often assume
|
|
|
|
that they get a WM_SIZE (EVT_SIZE) upon creation, however this broke
|
|
|
|
it. To see why, you should understand that Windows sends WM_SIZE from
|
|
|
|
inside ::CreateWindow() anyhow. However, ::CreateWindow() is called
|
|
|
|
from some base class ctor and so this WM_SIZE is not processed in the
|
|
|
|
real class' OnSize() (because it's not fully constructed yet and the
|
|
|
|
event goes to some base class OnSize() instead). So the WM_SIZE we
|
|
|
|
rely on is the one sent when the parent frame resizes its children
|
|
|
|
but here is the problem: if the child already has just the right
|
|
|
|
size, nothing will happen as both wxWidgets and Windows check for
|
|
|
|
this and ignore any attempts to change the window size to the size it
|
|
|
|
already has - so no WM_SIZE would be sent.
|
|
|
|
*/
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we don't use CW_USEDEFAULT here for several reasons:
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// 1. it results in huge frames on modern screens (1000*800 is not
|
|
|
|
// uncommon on my 1280*1024 screen) which is way too big for a half
|
|
|
|
// empty frame of most of wxWidgets samples for example)
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// 2. it is buggy for frames with wxFRAME_TOOL_WINDOW style for which
|
|
|
|
// the default is for whatever reason 8*8 which breaks client <->
|
|
|
|
// window size calculations (it would be nice if it didn't, but it
|
|
|
|
// does and the simplest way to fix it seemed to change the broken
|
|
|
|
// default size anyhow)
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// 3. there is just no advantage in doing it: with x and y it is
|
|
|
|
// possible that [future versions of] Windows position the new top
|
|
|
|
// level window in some smart way which we can't do, but we can
|
|
|
|
// guess a reasonably good size for a new window just as well
|
|
|
|
// ourselves
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// However, on PocketPC devices, we must use the default
|
|
|
|
// size if possible.
|
|
|
|
#ifdef _WIN32_WCE
|
|
|
|
if (size.x == wxDefaultCoord)
|
|
|
|
w = CW_USEDEFAULT;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
w = size.x;
|
|
|
|
if (size.y == wxDefaultCoord)
|
|
|
|
h = CW_USEDEFAULT;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
h = size.y;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
if ( size.x == wxDefaultCoord || size.y == wxDefaultCoord)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
nonDefault = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
w = WidthDefault(size.x);
|
|
|
|
h = HeightDefault(size.y);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
AdjustForParentClientOrigin(x, y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return nonDefault;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXHWND wxWindowMSW::MSWGetParent() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return m_parent ? m_parent->GetHWND() : WXHWND(NULL);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWCreate(const wxChar *wclass,
|
|
|
|
const wxChar *title,
|
|
|
|
const wxPoint& pos,
|
|
|
|
const wxSize& size,
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD style,
|
|
|
|
WXDWORD extendedStyle)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// choose the position/size for the new window
|
|
|
|
int x, y, w, h;
|
|
|
|
(void)MSWGetCreateWindowCoords(pos, size, x, y, w, h);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// controlId is menu handle for the top level windows, so set it to 0
|
|
|
|
// unless we're creating a child window
|
|
|
|
int controlId = style & WS_CHILD ? GetId() : 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// for each class "Foo" we have we also have "FooNR" ("no repaint") class
|
|
|
|
// which is the same but without CS_[HV]REDRAW class styles so using it
|
|
|
|
// ensures that the window is not fully repainted on each resize
|
|
|
|
wxString className(wclass);
|
|
|
|
if ( !HasFlag(wxFULL_REPAINT_ON_RESIZE) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
className += wxT("NR");
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// do create the window
|
|
|
|
wxWindowCreationHook hook(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_hWnd = (WXHWND)::CreateWindowEx
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
extendedStyle,
|
|
|
|
className,
|
|
|
|
title ? title : m_windowName.c_str(),
|
|
|
|
style,
|
|
|
|
x, y, w, h,
|
|
|
|
(HWND)MSWGetParent(),
|
|
|
|
(HMENU)controlId,
|
|
|
|
wxGetInstance(),
|
|
|
|
NULL // no extra data
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_hWnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogSysError(_("Can't create window of class %s"), className.c_str());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
SubclassWin(m_hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
// MSW message handlers
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// WM_NOTIFY
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleNotify(int idCtrl, WXLPARAM lParam, WXLPARAM *result)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
LPNMHDR hdr = (LPNMHDR)lParam;
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = hdr->hwndFrom;
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if the control is one of our windows, let it handle the message itself
|
|
|
|
if ( win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return win->MSWOnNotify(idCtrl, lParam, result);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// VZ: why did we do it? normally this is unnecessary and, besides, it
|
|
|
|
// breaks the message processing for the toolbars because the tooltip
|
|
|
|
// notifications were being forwarded to the toolbar child controls
|
|
|
|
// (if it had any) before being passed to the toolbar itself, so in my
|
|
|
|
// example the tooltip for the combobox was always shown instead of the
|
|
|
|
// correct button tooltips
|
|
|
|
#if 0
|
|
|
|
// try all our children
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while ( node )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *child = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( child->MSWOnNotify(idCtrl, lParam, result) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // 0
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// by default, handle it ourselves
|
|
|
|
return MSWOnNotify(idCtrl, lParam, result);
|
|
|
|
#else // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleTooltipNotify(WXUINT code,
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
const wxString& ttip)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// I don't know why it happens, but the versions of comctl32.dll starting
|
|
|
|
// from 4.70 sometimes send TTN_NEEDTEXTW even to ANSI programs (normally,
|
|
|
|
// this message is supposed to be sent to Unicode programs only) -- hence
|
|
|
|
// we need to handle it as well, otherwise no tooltips will be shown in
|
|
|
|
// this case
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( !(code == (WXUINT) TTN_NEEDTEXTA || code == (WXUINT) TTN_NEEDTEXTW)
|
|
|
|
|| ttip.empty() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// not a tooltip message or no tooltip to show anyhow
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
LPTOOLTIPTEXT ttText = (LPTOOLTIPTEXT)lParam;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We don't want to use the szText buffer because it has a limit of 80
|
|
|
|
// bytes and this is not enough, especially for Unicode build where it
|
|
|
|
// limits the tooltip string length to only 40 characters
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// The best would be, of course, to not impose any length limitations at
|
|
|
|
// all but then the buffer would have to be dynamic and someone would have
|
|
|
|
// to free it and we don't have the tooltip owner object here any more, so
|
|
|
|
// for now use our own static buffer with a higher fixed max length.
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// Note that using a static buffer should not be a problem as only a single
|
|
|
|
// tooltip can be shown at the same time anyhow.
|
|
|
|
#if !wxUSE_UNICODE
|
|
|
|
if ( code == (WXUINT) TTN_NEEDTEXTW )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// We need to convert tooltip from multi byte to Unicode on the fly.
|
|
|
|
static wchar_t buf[513];
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Truncate tooltip length if needed as otherwise we might not have
|
|
|
|
// enough space for it in the buffer and MultiByteToWideChar() would
|
|
|
|
// return an error
|
|
|
|
size_t tipLength = wxMin(ttip.length(), WXSIZEOF(buf) - 1);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Convert to WideChar without adding the NULL character. The NULL
|
|
|
|
// character is added afterwards (this is more efficient).
|
|
|
|
int len = ::MultiByteToWideChar
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
CP_ACP,
|
|
|
|
0, // no flags
|
|
|
|
ttip,
|
|
|
|
tipLength,
|
|
|
|
buf,
|
|
|
|
WXSIZEOF(buf) - 1
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !len )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("MultiByteToWideChar()"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
buf[len] = L'\0';
|
|
|
|
ttText->lpszText = (LPSTR) buf;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // TTN_NEEDTEXTA
|
|
|
|
#endif // !wxUSE_UNICODE
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we get here if we got TTN_NEEDTEXTA (only happens in ANSI build) or
|
|
|
|
// if we got TTN_NEEDTEXTW in Unicode build: in this case we just have
|
|
|
|
// to copy the string we have into the buffer
|
|
|
|
static wxChar buf[513];
|
|
|
|
wxStrncpy(buf, ttip.c_str(), WXSIZEOF(buf) - 1);
|
|
|
|
buf[WXSIZEOF(buf) - 1] = _T('\0');
|
|
|
|
ttText->lpszText = buf;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWOnNotify(int WXUNUSED(idCtrl),
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM* WXUNUSED(result))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
if ( m_tooltip )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
NMHDR* hdr = (NMHDR *)lParam;
|
|
|
|
if ( HandleTooltipNotify(hdr->code, lParam, m_tooltip->GetTip()))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// processed
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(lParam);
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_TOOLTIPS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// end session messages
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleQueryEndSession(long logOff, bool *mayEnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ENDSESSION_LOGOFF
|
|
|
|
wxCloseEvent event(wxEVT_QUERY_END_SESSION, wxID_ANY);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(wxTheApp);
|
|
|
|
event.SetCanVeto(true);
|
|
|
|
event.SetLoggingOff(logOff == (long)ENDSESSION_LOGOFF);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool rc = wxTheApp->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( rc )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we may end only if the app didn't veto session closing (double
|
|
|
|
// negation...)
|
|
|
|
*mayEnd = !event.GetVeto();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(logOff);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(mayEnd);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleEndSession(bool endSession, long logOff)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef ENDSESSION_LOGOFF
|
|
|
|
// do nothing if the session isn't ending
|
|
|
|
if ( !endSession )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// only send once
|
|
|
|
if ( (this != wxTheApp->GetTopWindow()) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCloseEvent event(wxEVT_END_SESSION, wxID_ANY);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(wxTheApp);
|
|
|
|
event.SetCanVeto(false);
|
|
|
|
event.SetLoggingOff((logOff & ENDSESSION_LOGOFF) != 0);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return wxTheApp->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(endSession);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(logOff);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// window creation/destruction
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleCreate(WXLPCREATESTRUCT WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(cs),
|
|
|
|
bool *mayCreate)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// VZ: why is this commented out for WinCE? If it doesn't support
|
|
|
|
// WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT at all it should be somehow handled globally,
|
|
|
|
// not with multiple #ifdef's!
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( ((CREATESTRUCT *)cs)->dwExStyle & WS_EX_CONTROLPARENT )
|
|
|
|
EnsureParentHasControlParentStyle(GetParent());
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*mayCreate = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleDestroy()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SendDestroyEvent();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// delete our drop target if we've got one
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
|
|
|
|
if ( m_dropTarget != NULL )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_dropTarget->Revoke(m_hWnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
delete m_dropTarget;
|
|
|
|
m_dropTarget = NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_DRAG_AND_DROP
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// WM_DESTROY handled
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// activation/focus
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleActivate(int state,
|
|
|
|
bool WXUNUSED(minimized),
|
|
|
|
WXHWND WXUNUSED(activate))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxActivateEvent event(wxEVT_ACTIVATE,
|
|
|
|
(state == WA_ACTIVE) || (state == WA_CLICKACTIVE),
|
|
|
|
m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSetFocus(WXHWND hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Strangly enough, some controls get set focus events when they are being
|
|
|
|
// deleted, even if they already had focus before.
|
|
|
|
if ( m_isBeingDeleted )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// notify the parent keeping track of focus for the kbd navigation
|
|
|
|
// purposes that we got it
|
|
|
|
wxChildFocusEvent eventFocus((wxWindow *)this);
|
|
|
|
(void)GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(eventFocus);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
// Deal with caret
|
|
|
|
if ( m_caret )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_caret->OnSetFocus();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
|
|
|
|
// If it's a wxTextCtrl don't send the event as it will be done
|
|
|
|
// after the control gets to process it from EN_FOCUS handler
|
|
|
|
if ( wxDynamicCastThis(wxTextCtrl) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxFocusEvent event(wxEVT_SET_FOCUS, m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// wxFindWinFromHandle() may return NULL, it is ok
|
|
|
|
event.SetWindow(wxFindWinFromHandle(hwnd));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleKillFocus(WXHWND hwnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
// Deal with caret
|
|
|
|
if ( m_caret )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_caret->OnKillFocus();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CARET
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_TEXTCTRL
|
|
|
|
// If it's a wxTextCtrl don't send the event as it will be done
|
|
|
|
// after the control gets to process it.
|
|
|
|
wxTextCtrl *ctrl = wxDynamicCastThis(wxTextCtrl);
|
|
|
|
if ( ctrl )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Don't send the event when in the process of being deleted. This can
|
|
|
|
// only cause problems if the event handler tries to access the object.
|
|
|
|
if ( m_isBeingDeleted )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxFocusEvent event(wxEVT_KILL_FOCUS, m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// wxFindWinFromHandle() may return NULL, it is ok
|
|
|
|
event.SetWindow(wxFindWinFromHandle(hwnd));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// labels
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetLabel( const wxString& label)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SetWindowText(GetHwnd(), label.c_str());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxString wxWindowMSW::GetLabel() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return wxGetWindowText(GetHWND());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// miscellaneous
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleShow(bool show, int WXUNUSED(status))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxShowEvent event(GetId(), show);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleInitDialog(WXHWND WXUNUSED(hWndFocus))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxInitDialogEvent event(GetId());
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleDropFiles(WXWPARAM wParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if defined (__WXMICROWIN__) || defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(wParam);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#else // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
HDROP hFilesInfo = (HDROP) wParam;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Get the total number of files dropped
|
|
|
|
UINT gwFilesDropped = ::DragQueryFile
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
(HDROP)hFilesInfo,
|
|
|
|
(UINT)-1,
|
|
|
|
(LPTSTR)0,
|
|
|
|
(UINT)0
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxString *files = new wxString[gwFilesDropped];
|
|
|
|
for ( UINT wIndex = 0; wIndex < gwFilesDropped; wIndex++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// first get the needed buffer length (+1 for terminating NUL)
|
|
|
|
size_t len = ::DragQueryFile(hFilesInfo, wIndex, NULL, 0) + 1;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and now get the file name
|
|
|
|
::DragQueryFile(hFilesInfo, wIndex,
|
|
|
|
wxStringBuffer(files[wIndex], len), len);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
DragFinish (hFilesInfo);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxDropFilesEvent event(wxEVT_DROP_FILES, gwFilesDropped, files);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
POINT dropPoint;
|
|
|
|
DragQueryPoint(hFilesInfo, (LPPOINT) &dropPoint);
|
|
|
|
event.m_pos.x = dropPoint.x;
|
|
|
|
event.m_pos.y = dropPoint.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSetCursor(WXHWND WXUNUSED(hWnd),
|
|
|
|
short nHitTest,
|
|
|
|
int WXUNUSED(mouseMsg))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
// the logic is as follows:
|
|
|
|
// -1. don't set cursor for non client area, including but not limited to
|
|
|
|
// the title bar, scrollbars, &c
|
|
|
|
// 0. allow the user to override default behaviour by using EVT_SET_CURSOR
|
|
|
|
// 1. if we have the cursor set it unless wxIsBusy()
|
|
|
|
// 2. if we're a top level window, set some cursor anyhow
|
|
|
|
// 3. if wxIsBusy(), set the busy cursor, otherwise the global one
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( nHitTest != HTCLIENT )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HCURSOR hcursor = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// first ask the user code - it may wish to set the cursor in some very
|
|
|
|
// specific way (for example, depending on the current position)
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetCursorPosWinCE(&pt))
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetCursorPos(&pt) )
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("GetCursorPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int x = pt.x,
|
|
|
|
y = pt.y;
|
|
|
|
ScreenToClient(&x, &y);
|
|
|
|
wxSetCursorEvent event(x, y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool processedEvtSetCursor = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
if ( processedEvtSetCursor && event.HasCursor() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hcursor = GetHcursorOf(event.GetCursor());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !hcursor )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
bool isBusy = wxIsBusy();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the test for processedEvtSetCursor is here to prevent using m_cursor
|
|
|
|
// if the user code caught EVT_SET_CURSOR() and returned nothing from
|
|
|
|
// it - this is a way to say that our cursor shouldn't be used for this
|
|
|
|
// point
|
|
|
|
if ( !processedEvtSetCursor && m_cursor.Ok() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hcursor = GetHcursorOf(m_cursor);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !GetParent() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( isBusy )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hcursor = wxGetCurrentBusyCursor();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else if ( !hcursor )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const wxCursor *cursor = wxGetGlobalCursor();
|
|
|
|
if ( cursor && cursor->Ok() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hcursor = GetHcursorOf(*cursor);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( hcursor )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// wxLogDebug("HandleSetCursor: Setting cursor %ld", (long) hcursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::SetCursor(hcursor);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// cursor set, stop here
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// pass up the window chain
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandlePower(WXWPARAM WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(wParam),
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM WXUNUSED(lParam),
|
|
|
|
bool *WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(vetoed))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// FIXME
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxEventType evtType;
|
|
|
|
switch ( wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMQUERYSUSPEND:
|
|
|
|
evtType = wxEVT_POWER_SUSPENDING;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMQUERYSUSPENDFAILED:
|
|
|
|
evtType = wxEVT_POWER_SUSPEND_CANCEL;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMSUSPEND:
|
|
|
|
evtType = wxEVT_POWER_SUSPENDED;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMRESUMESUSPEND:
|
|
|
|
#ifdef PBT_APMRESUMEAUTOMATIC
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMRESUMEAUTOMATIC:
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
evtType = wxEVT_POWER_RESUME;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
wxLogDebug(_T("Unknown WM_POWERBROADCAST(%d) event"), wParam);
|
|
|
|
// fall through
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// these messages are currently not mapped to wx events
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMQUERYSTANDBY:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMQUERYSTANDBYFAILED:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMSTANDBY:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMRESUMESTANDBY:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMBATTERYLOW:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMPOWERSTATUSCHANGE:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMOEMEVENT:
|
|
|
|
case PBT_APMRESUMECRITICAL:
|
|
|
|
evtType = wxEVT_NULL;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't handle unknown messages
|
|
|
|
if ( evtType == wxEVT_NULL )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// TODO: notify about PBTF_APMRESUMEFROMFAILURE in case of resume events?
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPowerEvent event(evtType);
|
|
|
|
if ( !GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event) )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
*vetoed = event.IsVetoed();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::IsDoubleBuffered() const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const wxWindowMSW *wnd = this;
|
|
|
|
do {
|
|
|
|
long style = ::GetWindowLong(GetHwndOf(wnd), GWL_EXSTYLE);
|
|
|
|
if ( (style & WS_EX_COMPOSITED) != 0 )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
wnd = wnd->GetParent();
|
|
|
|
} while ( wnd && !wnd->IsTopLevel() );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::SetDoubleBuffered(bool on)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Get the current extended style bits
|
|
|
|
long exstyle = ::GetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_EXSTYLE);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Twiddle the bit as needed
|
|
|
|
if ( on )
|
|
|
|
exstyle |= WS_EX_COMPOSITED;
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
exstyle &= ~WS_EX_COMPOSITED;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// put it back
|
|
|
|
::SetWindowLong(GetHwnd(), GWL_EXSTYLE, exstyle);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// owner drawn stuff
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if (wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN && wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE) || \
|
|
|
|
(wxUSE_CONTROLS && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__))
|
|
|
|
#define WXUNUSED_UNLESS_ODRAWN(param) param
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
#define WXUNUSED_UNLESS_ODRAWN(param)
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::MSWOnDrawItem(int WXUNUSED_UNLESS_ODRAWN(id),
|
|
|
|
WXDRAWITEMSTRUCT * WXUNUSED_UNLESS_ODRAWN(itemStruct))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
// is it a menu item?
|
|
|
|
DRAWITEMSTRUCT *pDrawStruct = (DRAWITEMSTRUCT *)itemStruct;
|
|
|
|
if ( id == 0 && pDrawStruct->CtlType == ODT_MENU )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMenuItem *pMenuItem = (wxMenuItem *)(pDrawStruct->itemData);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// see comment before the same test in MSWOnMeasureItem() below
|
|
|
|
if ( !pMenuItem )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( wxDynamicCast(pMenuItem, wxMenuItem),
|
|
|
|
false, _T("MSWOnDrawItem: bad wxMenuItem pointer") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// prepare to call OnDrawItem(): notice using of wxDCTemp to prevent
|
|
|
|
// the DC from being released
|
|
|
|
wxDCTemp dc((WXHDC)pDrawStruct->hDC);
|
|
|
|
wxRect rect(pDrawStruct->rcItem.left, pDrawStruct->rcItem.top,
|
|
|
|
pDrawStruct->rcItem.right - pDrawStruct->rcItem.left,
|
|
|
|
pDrawStruct->rcItem.bottom - pDrawStruct->rcItem.top);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return pMenuItem->OnDrawItem
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
dc,
|
|
|
|
rect,
|
|
|
|
(wxOwnerDrawn::wxODAction)pDrawStruct->itemAction,
|
|
|
|
(wxOwnerDrawn::wxODStatus)pDrawStruct->itemState
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_OWNER_DRAWN
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CONTROLS && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN
|
|
|
|
wxControl *item = wxDynamicCast(FindItem(id), wxControl);
|
|
|
|
#else // !wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN
|
|
|
|
// we may still have owner-drawn buttons internally because we have to make
|
|
|
|
// them owner-drawn to support colour change
|
|
|
|
wxControl *item =
|
|
|
|
# if wxUSE_BUTTON
|
|
|
|
wxDynamicCast(FindItem(id), wxButton)
|
|
|
|
# else
|
|
|
|
NULL
|
|
|
|
# endif
|
|
|
|
;
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_OWNER_DRAWN
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( item )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return item->MSWOnDraw(itemStruct);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::MSWOnMeasureItem(int id, WXMEASUREITEMSTRUCT *itemStruct)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN && wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
// is it a menu item?
|
|
|
|
MEASUREITEMSTRUCT *pMeasureStruct = (MEASUREITEMSTRUCT *)itemStruct;
|
|
|
|
if ( id == 0 && pMeasureStruct->CtlType == ODT_MENU )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMenuItem *pMenuItem = (wxMenuItem *)(pMeasureStruct->itemData);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// according to Carsten Fuchs the pointer may be NULL under XP if an
|
|
|
|
// MDI child frame is initially maximized, see this for more info:
|
|
|
|
// http://article.gmane.org/gmane.comp.lib.wxwidgets.general/27745
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// so silently ignore it instead of asserting
|
|
|
|
if ( !pMenuItem )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( wxDynamicCast(pMenuItem, wxMenuItem),
|
|
|
|
false, _T("MSWOnMeasureItem: bad wxMenuItem pointer") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
size_t w, h;
|
|
|
|
bool rc = pMenuItem->OnMeasureItem(&w, &h);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
pMeasureStruct->itemWidth = w;
|
|
|
|
pMeasureStruct->itemHeight = h;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxControl *item = wxDynamicCast(FindItem(id), wxControl);
|
|
|
|
if ( item )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return item->MSWOnMeasure(itemStruct);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(id);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(itemStruct);
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_OWNER_DRAWN && wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// colours and palettes
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSysColorChange()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxSysColourChangedEvent event;
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(void)GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// always let the system carry on the default processing to allow the
|
|
|
|
// native controls to react to the colours update
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleDisplayChange()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxDisplayChangedEvent event;
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleCtlColor(WXHBRUSH *brush, WXHDC hDC, WXHWND hWnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if !wxUSE_CONTROLS || defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(hDC);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(hWnd);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxControl *item = wxDynamicCast(FindItemByHWND(hWnd, true), wxControl);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( item )
|
|
|
|
*brush = item->MSWControlColor(hDC, hWnd);
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_CONTROLS
|
|
|
|
*brush = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return *brush != NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandlePaletteChanged(WXHWND hWndPalChange)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_PALETTE
|
|
|
|
// same as below except we don't respond to our own messages
|
|
|
|
if ( hWndPalChange != GetHWND() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// check to see if we our our parents have a custom palette
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *win = this;
|
|
|
|
while ( win && !win->HasCustomPalette() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = win->GetParent();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( win && win->HasCustomPalette() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// realize the palette to see whether redrawing is needed
|
|
|
|
HDC hdc = ::GetDC((HWND) hWndPalChange);
|
|
|
|
win->m_palette.SetHPALETTE((WXHPALETTE)
|
|
|
|
::SelectPalette(hdc, GetHpaletteOf(win->m_palette), FALSE));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int result = ::RealizePalette(hdc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// restore the palette (before releasing the DC)
|
|
|
|
win->m_palette.SetHPALETTE((WXHPALETTE)
|
|
|
|
::SelectPalette(hdc, GetHpaletteOf(win->m_palette), FALSE));
|
|
|
|
::RealizePalette(hdc);
|
|
|
|
::ReleaseDC((HWND) hWndPalChange, hdc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// now check for the need to redraw
|
|
|
|
if (result > 0)
|
|
|
|
::InvalidateRect((HWND) hWndPalChange, NULL, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_PALETTE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPaletteChangedEvent event(GetId());
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
event.SetChangedWindow(wxFindWinFromHandle(hWndPalChange));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleCaptureChanged(WXHWND hWndGainedCapture)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// notify windows on the capture stack about lost capture
|
|
|
|
// (see http://sourceforge.net/tracker/index.php?func=detail&aid=1153662&group_id=9863&atid=109863):
|
|
|
|
wxWindowBase::NotifyCaptureLost();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = wxFindWinFromHandle(hWndGainedCapture);
|
|
|
|
wxMouseCaptureChangedEvent event(GetId(), win);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSettingChange(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// despite MSDN saying "(This message cannot be sent directly to a window.)"
|
|
|
|
// we need to send this to child windows (it is only sent to top-level
|
|
|
|
// windows) so {list,tree}ctrls can adjust their font size if necessary
|
|
|
|
// this is exactly how explorer does it to enable the font size changes
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while ( node )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// top-level windows already get this message from the system
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( !win->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(GetHwndOf(win), WM_SETTINGCHANGE, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// let the system handle it
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleQueryNewPalette()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_PALETTE
|
|
|
|
// check to see if we our our parents have a custom palette
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *win = this;
|
|
|
|
while (!win->HasCustomPalette() && win->GetParent()) win = win->GetParent();
|
|
|
|
if (win->HasCustomPalette()) {
|
|
|
|
/* realize the palette to see whether redrawing is needed */
|
|
|
|
HDC hdc = ::GetDC((HWND) GetHWND());
|
|
|
|
win->m_palette.SetHPALETTE( (WXHPALETTE)
|
|
|
|
::SelectPalette(hdc, (HPALETTE) win->m_palette.GetHPALETTE(), FALSE) );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int result = ::RealizePalette(hdc);
|
|
|
|
/* restore the palette (before releasing the DC) */
|
|
|
|
win->m_palette.SetHPALETTE( (WXHPALETTE)
|
|
|
|
::SelectPalette(hdc, (HPALETTE) win->m_palette.GetHPALETTE(), TRUE) );
|
|
|
|
::RealizePalette(hdc);
|
|
|
|
::ReleaseDC((HWND) GetHWND(), hdc);
|
|
|
|
/* now check for the need to redraw */
|
|
|
|
if (result > 0)
|
|
|
|
::InvalidateRect((HWND) GetHWND(), NULL, TRUE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_PALETTE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxQueryNewPaletteEvent event(GetId());
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event) && event.GetPaletteRealized();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Responds to colour changes: passes event on to children.
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::OnSysColourChanged(wxSysColourChangedEvent& WXUNUSED(event))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// the top level window also reset the standard colour map as it might have
|
|
|
|
// changed (there is no need to do it for the non top level windows as we
|
|
|
|
// only have to do it once)
|
|
|
|
if ( IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// FIXME-MT
|
|
|
|
gs_hasStdCmap = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while ( node )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Only propagate to non-top-level windows because Windows already
|
|
|
|
// sends this event to all top-level ones
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
if ( !win->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we need to send the real WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE and not just trigger
|
|
|
|
// EVT_SYS_COLOUR_CHANGED call because the latter wouldn't work for
|
|
|
|
// the standard controls
|
|
|
|
::SendMessage(GetHwndOf(win), WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE, 0, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern wxCOLORMAP *wxGetStdColourMap()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
static COLORREF s_stdColours[wxSTD_COL_MAX];
|
|
|
|
static wxCOLORMAP s_cmap[wxSTD_COL_MAX];
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !gs_hasStdCmap )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
static bool s_coloursInit = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !s_coloursInit )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// When a bitmap is loaded, the RGB values can change (apparently
|
|
|
|
// because Windows adjusts them to care for the old programs always
|
|
|
|
// using 0xc0c0c0 while the transparent colour for the new Windows
|
|
|
|
// versions is different). But we do this adjustment ourselves so
|
|
|
|
// we want to avoid Windows' "help" and for this we need to have a
|
|
|
|
// reference bitmap which can tell us what the RGB values change
|
|
|
|
// to.
|
|
|
|
wxLogNull logNo; // suppress error if we couldn't load the bitmap
|
|
|
|
wxBitmap stdColourBitmap(_T("wxBITMAP_STD_COLOURS"));
|
|
|
|
if ( stdColourBitmap.Ok() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// the pixels in the bitmap must correspond to wxSTD_COL_XXX!
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( stdColourBitmap.GetWidth() == wxSTD_COL_MAX,
|
|
|
|
_T("forgot to update wxBITMAP_STD_COLOURS!") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxMemoryDC memDC;
|
|
|
|
memDC.SelectObject(stdColourBitmap);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxColour colour;
|
|
|
|
for ( size_t i = 0; i < WXSIZEOF(s_stdColours); i++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
memDC.GetPixel(i, 0, &colour);
|
|
|
|
s_stdColours[i] = wxColourToRGB(colour);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // wxBITMAP_STD_COLOURS couldn't be loaded
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
s_stdColours[0] = RGB(000,000,000); // black
|
|
|
|
s_stdColours[1] = RGB(128,128,128); // dark grey
|
|
|
|
s_stdColours[2] = RGB(192,192,192); // light grey
|
|
|
|
s_stdColours[3] = RGB(255,255,255); // white
|
|
|
|
//s_stdColours[4] = RGB(000,000,255); // blue
|
|
|
|
//s_stdColours[5] = RGB(255,000,255); // magenta
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
s_coloursInit = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
gs_hasStdCmap = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// create the colour map
|
|
|
|
#define INIT_CMAP_ENTRY(col) \
|
|
|
|
s_cmap[wxSTD_COL_##col].from = s_stdColours[wxSTD_COL_##col]; \
|
|
|
|
s_cmap[wxSTD_COL_##col].to = ::GetSysColor(COLOR_##col)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
INIT_CMAP_ENTRY(BTNTEXT);
|
|
|
|
INIT_CMAP_ENTRY(BTNSHADOW);
|
|
|
|
INIT_CMAP_ENTRY(BTNFACE);
|
|
|
|
INIT_CMAP_ENTRY(BTNHIGHLIGHT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#undef INIT_CMAP_ENTRY
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return s_cmap;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// painting
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandlePaint()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HRGN hRegion = ::CreateRectRgn(0, 0, 0, 0); // Dummy call to get a handle
|
|
|
|
if ( !hRegion )
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("CreateRectRgn"));
|
|
|
|
if ( ::GetUpdateRgn(GetHwnd(), hRegion, FALSE) == ERROR )
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(wxT("GetUpdateRgn"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
m_updateRegion = wxRegion((WXHRGN) hRegion);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxPaintEvent event(m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool processed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// note that we must generate NC event after the normal one as otherwise
|
|
|
|
// BeginPaint() will happily overwrite our decorations with the background
|
|
|
|
// colour
|
|
|
|
wxNcPaintEvent eventNc(m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
eventNc.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(eventNc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// don't keep an HRGN we don't need any longer (GetUpdateRegion() can only
|
|
|
|
// be called from inside the event handlers called above)
|
|
|
|
m_updateRegion.Clear();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return processed;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Can be called from an application's OnPaint handler
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::OnPaint(wxPaintEvent& event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXUNIVERSAL__
|
|
|
|
event.Skip();
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
HDC hDC = (HDC) wxPaintDC::FindDCInCache((wxWindow*) event.GetEventObject());
|
|
|
|
if (hDC != 0)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
MSWDefWindowProc(WM_PAINT, (WPARAM) hDC, 0);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleEraseBkgnd(WXHDC hdc)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxDCTemp dc(hdc, GetClientSize());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
dc.SetHDC(hdc);
|
|
|
|
dc.SetWindow((wxWindow *)this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxEraseEvent event(m_windowId, &dc);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
bool rc = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// must be called manually as ~wxDC doesn't do anything for wxDCTemp
|
|
|
|
dc.SelectOldObjects(hdc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::OnEraseBackground(wxEraseEvent& event)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// standard non top level controls (i.e. except the dialogs) always erase
|
|
|
|
// their background themselves in HandleCtlColor() or have some control-
|
|
|
|
// specific ways to set the colours (common controls)
|
|
|
|
if ( IsOfStandardClass() && !IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event.Skip();
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( GetBackgroundStyle() == wxBG_STYLE_CUSTOM )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// don't skip the event here, custom background means that the app
|
|
|
|
// is drawing it itself in its OnPaint(), so don't draw it at all
|
|
|
|
// now to avoid flicker
|
|
|
|
return;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// do default background painting
|
|
|
|
if ( !DoEraseBackground(GetHdcOf(*event.GetDC())) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// let the system paint the background
|
|
|
|
event.Skip();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::DoEraseBackground(WXHDC hDC)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HBRUSH hbr = (HBRUSH)MSWGetBgBrush(hDC);
|
|
|
|
if ( !hbr )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxFillRect(GetHwnd(), (HDC)hDC, hbr);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXHBRUSH
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW::MSWGetBgBrushForChild(WXHDC WXUNUSED(hDC), WXHWND hWnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( m_hasBgCol )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// our background colour applies to:
|
|
|
|
// 1. this window itself, always
|
|
|
|
// 2. all children unless the colour is "not inheritable"
|
|
|
|
// 3. even if it is not inheritable, our immediate transparent
|
|
|
|
// children should still inherit it -- but not any transparent
|
|
|
|
// children because it would look wrong if a child of non
|
|
|
|
// transparent child would show our bg colour when the child itself
|
|
|
|
// does not
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = wxFindWinFromHandle(hWnd);
|
|
|
|
if ( win == this ||
|
|
|
|
m_inheritBgCol ||
|
|
|
|
(win && win->HasTransparentBackground() &&
|
|
|
|
win->GetParent() == this) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// draw children with the same colour as the parent
|
|
|
|
wxBrush *
|
|
|
|
brush = wxTheBrushList->FindOrCreateBrush(GetBackgroundColour());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return (WXHBRUSH)GetHbrushOf(*brush);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXHBRUSH wxWindowMSW::MSWGetBgBrush(WXHDC hDC, WXHWND hWndToPaint)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !hWndToPaint )
|
|
|
|
hWndToPaint = GetHWND();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowMSW *win = this; win; win = win->GetParent() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WXHBRUSH hBrush = win->MSWGetBgBrushForChild(hDC, hWndToPaint);
|
|
|
|
if ( hBrush )
|
|
|
|
return hBrush;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// background is not inherited beyond top level windows
|
|
|
|
if ( win->IsTopLevel() )
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandlePrintClient(WXHDC hDC)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// we receive this message when DrawThemeParentBackground() is
|
|
|
|
// called from def window proc of several controls under XP and we
|
|
|
|
// must draw properly themed background here
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// note that naively I'd expect filling the client rect with the
|
|
|
|
// brush returned by MSWGetBgBrush() work -- but for some reason it
|
|
|
|
// doesn't and we have to call parents MSWPrintChild() which is
|
|
|
|
// supposed to call DrawThemeBackground() with appropriate params
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// also note that in this case lParam == PRF_CLIENT but we're
|
|
|
|
// clearly expected to paint the background and nothing else!
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( IsTopLevel() || InheritsBackgroundColour() )
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// sometimes we don't want the parent to handle it at all, instead
|
|
|
|
// return whatever value this window wants
|
|
|
|
if ( !MSWShouldPropagatePrintChild() )
|
|
|
|
return MSWPrintChild(hDC, (wxWindow *)this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindow *win = GetParent(); win; win = win->GetParent() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( win->MSWPrintChild(hDC, (wxWindow *)this) )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( win->IsTopLevel() || win->InheritsBackgroundColour() )
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// moving and resizing
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMinimize()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxIconizeEvent event(m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMaximize()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMaximizeEvent event(m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMove(int x, int y)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxPoint point(x,y);
|
|
|
|
wxMoveEvent event(point, m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMoving(wxRect& rect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMoveEvent event(rect, m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool rc = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
if (rc)
|
|
|
|
rect = event.GetRect();
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSize(int WXUNUSED(w), int WXUNUSED(h), WXUINT wParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
// when we resize this window, its children are probably going to be
|
|
|
|
// repositioned as well, prepare to use DeferWindowPos() for them
|
|
|
|
int numChildren = 0;
|
|
|
|
for ( HWND child = ::GetWindow(GetHwndOf(this), GW_CHILD);
|
|
|
|
child;
|
|
|
|
child = ::GetWindow(child, GW_HWNDNEXT) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
numChildren ++;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Protect against valid m_hDWP being overwritten
|
|
|
|
bool useDefer = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( numChildren > 1 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (!m_hDWP)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_hDWP = (WXHANDLE)::BeginDeferWindowPos(numChildren);
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_hDWP )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("BeginDeferWindowPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (m_hDWP)
|
|
|
|
useDefer = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// update this window size
|
|
|
|
bool processed = false;
|
|
|
|
switch ( wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
wxFAIL_MSG( _T("unexpected WM_SIZE parameter") );
|
|
|
|
// fall through nevertheless
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SIZE_MAXHIDE:
|
|
|
|
case SIZE_MAXSHOW:
|
|
|
|
// we're not interested in these messages at all
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SIZE_MINIMIZED:
|
|
|
|
processed = HandleMinimize();
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SIZE_MAXIMIZED:
|
|
|
|
/* processed = */ HandleMaximize();
|
|
|
|
// fall through to send a normal size event as well
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SIZE_RESTORED:
|
|
|
|
// don't use w and h parameters as they specify the client size
|
|
|
|
// while according to the docs EVT_SIZE handler is supposed to
|
|
|
|
// receive the total size
|
|
|
|
wxSizeEvent event(GetSize(), m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
processed = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
// and finally change the positions of all child windows at once
|
|
|
|
if ( useDefer && m_hDWP )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// reset m_hDWP to NULL so that child windows don't try to use our
|
|
|
|
// m_hDWP after we call EndDeferWindowPos() on it (this shouldn't
|
|
|
|
// happen anyhow normally but who knows what weird flow of control we
|
|
|
|
// may have depending on what the users EVT_SIZE handler does...)
|
|
|
|
HDWP hDWP = (HDWP)m_hDWP;
|
|
|
|
m_hDWP = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// do put all child controls in place at once
|
|
|
|
if ( !::EndDeferWindowPos(hDWP) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("EndDeferWindowPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Reset our children's pending pos/size values.
|
|
|
|
for ( wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator node = GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
node;
|
|
|
|
node = node->GetNext() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindowMSW *child = node->GetData();
|
|
|
|
child->m_pendingPosition = wxDefaultPosition;
|
|
|
|
child->m_pendingSize = wxDefaultSize;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // USE_DEFERRED_SIZING
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return processed;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleSizing(wxRect& rect)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxSizeEvent event(rect, m_windowId);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool rc = GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
if (rc)
|
|
|
|
rect = event.GetRect();
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleGetMinMaxInfo(void *WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(mmInfo))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
MINMAXINFO *info = (MINMAXINFO *)mmInfo;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool rc = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int minWidth = GetMinWidth(),
|
|
|
|
minHeight = GetMinHeight(),
|
|
|
|
maxWidth = GetMaxWidth(),
|
|
|
|
maxHeight = GetMaxHeight();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( minWidth != wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
info->ptMinTrackSize.x = minWidth;
|
|
|
|
rc = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( minHeight != wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
info->ptMinTrackSize.y = minHeight;
|
|
|
|
rc = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( maxWidth != wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
info->ptMaxTrackSize.x = maxWidth;
|
|
|
|
rc = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( maxHeight != wxDefaultCoord )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
info->ptMaxTrackSize.y = maxHeight;
|
|
|
|
rc = true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return rc;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// command messages
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleCommand(WXWORD id, WXWORD cmd, WXHWND control)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
if ( !cmd && wxCurrentPopupMenu )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMenu *popupMenu = wxCurrentPopupMenu;
|
|
|
|
wxCurrentPopupMenu = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return popupMenu->MSWCommand(cmd, id);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MENUS_NATIVE
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = NULL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// first try to find it from HWND - this works even with the broken
|
|
|
|
// programs using the same ids for different controls
|
|
|
|
if ( control )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = wxFindWinFromHandle(control);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// try the id
|
|
|
|
if ( !win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// must cast to a signed type before comparing with other ids!
|
|
|
|
win = FindItem((signed short)id);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return win->MSWCommand(cmd, id);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the messages sent from the in-place edit control used by the treectrl
|
|
|
|
// for label editing have id == 0, but they should _not_ be treated as menu
|
|
|
|
// messages (they are EN_XXX ones, in fact) so don't translate anything
|
|
|
|
// coming from a control to wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED
|
|
|
|
if ( !control )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// If no child window, it may be an accelerator, e.g. for a popup menu
|
|
|
|
// command
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxCommandEvent event(wxEVT_COMMAND_MENU_SELECTED);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(id);
|
|
|
|
event.SetInt(id);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_SPINCTRL && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
// the text ctrl which is logically part of wxSpinCtrl sends WM_COMMAND
|
|
|
|
// notifications to its parent which we want to reflect back to
|
|
|
|
// wxSpinCtrl
|
|
|
|
wxSpinCtrl *spin = wxSpinCtrl::GetSpinForTextCtrl(control);
|
|
|
|
if ( spin && spin->ProcessTextCommand(cmd, id) )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_SPINCTRL
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_CHOICE && defined(__SMARTPHONE__)
|
|
|
|
// the listbox ctrl which is logically part of wxChoice sends WM_COMMAND
|
|
|
|
// notifications to its parent which we want to reflect back to
|
|
|
|
// wxChoice
|
|
|
|
wxChoice *choice = wxChoice::GetChoiceForListBox(control);
|
|
|
|
if ( choice && choice->MSWCommand(cmd, id) )
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// mouse events
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::InitMouseEvent(wxMouseEvent& event,
|
|
|
|
int x, int y,
|
|
|
|
WXUINT flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// our client coords are not quite the same as Windows ones
|
|
|
|
wxPoint pt = GetClientAreaOrigin();
|
|
|
|
event.m_x = x - pt.x;
|
|
|
|
event.m_y = y - pt.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.m_shiftDown = (flags & MK_SHIFT) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_controlDown = (flags & MK_CONTROL) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_leftDown = (flags & MK_LBUTTON) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_middleDown = (flags & MK_MBUTTON) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_rightDown = (flags & MK_RBUTTON) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_altDown = ::GetKeyState(VK_MENU) < 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
event.SetTimestamp(::GetMessageTime());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(GetId());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.pos = ClientToScreen(wxPoint(x, y));
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.type = event.GetEventType();
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
// Windows doesn't send the mouse events to the static controls (which are
|
|
|
|
// transparent in the sense that their WM_NCHITTEST handler returns
|
|
|
|
// HTTRANSPARENT) at all but we want all controls to receive the mouse events
|
|
|
|
// and so we manually check if we don't have a child window under mouse and if
|
|
|
|
// we do, send the event to it instead of the window Windows had sent WM_XXX
|
|
|
|
// to.
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// Notice that this is not done for the mouse move events because this could
|
|
|
|
// (would?) be too slow, but only for clicks which means that the static texts
|
|
|
|
// still don't get move, enter nor leave events.
|
|
|
|
static wxWindowMSW *FindWindowForMouseEvent(wxWindowMSW *win, int *x, int *y)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxCHECK_MSG( x && y, win, _T("NULL pointer in FindWindowForMouseEvent") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// first try to find a non transparent child: this allows us to send events
|
|
|
|
// to a static text which is inside a static box, for example
|
|
|
|
POINT pt = { *x, *y };
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = GetHwndOf(win),
|
|
|
|
hwndUnderMouse;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
hwndUnderMouse = ::ChildWindowFromPoint
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
hwnd,
|
|
|
|
pt
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
hwndUnderMouse = ::ChildWindowFromPointEx
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
hwnd,
|
|
|
|
pt,
|
|
|
|
CWP_SKIPINVISIBLE |
|
|
|
|
CWP_SKIPDISABLED |
|
|
|
|
CWP_SKIPTRANSPARENT
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !hwndUnderMouse || hwndUnderMouse == hwnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// now try any child window at all
|
|
|
|
hwndUnderMouse = ::ChildWindowFromPoint(hwnd, pt);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// check that we have a child window which is susceptible to receive mouse
|
|
|
|
// events: for this it must be shown and enabled
|
|
|
|
if ( hwndUnderMouse &&
|
|
|
|
hwndUnderMouse != hwnd &&
|
|
|
|
::IsWindowVisible(hwndUnderMouse) &&
|
|
|
|
::IsWindowEnabled(hwndUnderMouse) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *winUnderMouse = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)hwndUnderMouse);
|
|
|
|
if ( winUnderMouse )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// translate the mouse coords to the other window coords
|
|
|
|
win->ClientToScreen(x, y);
|
|
|
|
winUnderMouse->ScreenToClient(x, y);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
win = winUnderMouse;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return win;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMouseEvent(WXUINT msg, int x, int y, WXUINT flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// the mouse events take consecutive IDs from WM_MOUSEFIRST to
|
|
|
|
// WM_MOUSELAST, so it's enough to subtract WM_MOUSEMOVE == WM_MOUSEFIRST
|
|
|
|
// from the message id and take the value in the table to get wxWin event
|
|
|
|
// id
|
|
|
|
static const wxEventType eventsMouse[] =
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_MOTION,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_LEFT_UP,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_LEFT_DCLICK,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_RIGHT_DOWN,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_RIGHT_UP,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_RIGHT_DCLICK,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_MIDDLE_DOWN,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_MIDDLE_UP,
|
|
|
|
wxEVT_MIDDLE_DCLICK
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxMouseEvent event(eventsMouse[msg - WM_MOUSEMOVE]);
|
|
|
|
InitMouseEvent(event, x, y, flags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMouseMove(int x, int y, WXUINT flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !m_mouseInWindow )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it would be wrong to assume that just because we get a mouse move
|
|
|
|
// event that the mouse is inside the window: although this is usually
|
|
|
|
// true, it is not if we had captured the mouse, so we need to check
|
|
|
|
// the mouse coordinates here
|
|
|
|
if ( !HasCapture() || IsMouseInWindow() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Generate an ENTER event
|
|
|
|
m_mouseInWindow = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
typedef BOOL (WINAPI *_TrackMouseEvent_t)(LPTRACKMOUSEEVENT);
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
static const _TrackMouseEvent_t
|
|
|
|
s_pfn_TrackMouseEvent = _TrackMouseEvent;
|
|
|
|
#else // !__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
static _TrackMouseEvent_t s_pfn_TrackMouseEvent;
|
|
|
|
static bool s_initDone = false;
|
|
|
|
if ( !s_initDone )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogNull noLog;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxDynamicLibrary dllComCtl32(_T("comctl32.dll"), wxDL_VERBATIM);
|
|
|
|
if ( dllComCtl32.IsLoaded() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
s_pfn_TrackMouseEvent = (_TrackMouseEvent_t)
|
|
|
|
dllComCtl32.GetSymbol(_T("_TrackMouseEvent"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
s_initDone = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// notice that it's ok to unload comctl32.dll here as it won't
|
|
|
|
// be really unloaded, being still in use because we link to it
|
|
|
|
// statically too
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( s_pfn_TrackMouseEvent )
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__/!__WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<TRACKMOUSEEVENT> trackinfo;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
trackinfo.dwFlags = TME_LEAVE;
|
|
|
|
trackinfo.hwndTrack = GetHwnd();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(*s_pfn_TrackMouseEvent)(&trackinfo);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxMouseEvent event(wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW);
|
|
|
|
InitMouseEvent(event, x, y, flags);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(void)GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#ifdef HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
else // mouse not in window
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Check if we need to send a LEAVE event
|
|
|
|
// Windows doesn't send WM_MOUSELEAVE if the mouse has been captured so
|
|
|
|
// send it here if we are using native mouse leave tracking
|
|
|
|
if ( HasCapture() && !IsMouseInWindow() )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
GenerateMouseLeave();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // HAVE_TRACKMOUSEEVENT
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
// Windows often generates mouse events even if mouse position hasn't
|
|
|
|
// changed (http://article.gmane.org/gmane.comp.lib.wxwidgets.devel/66576)
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// Filter this out as it can result in unexpected behaviour compared to
|
|
|
|
// other platforms
|
|
|
|
if ( gs_lastMouseEvent.type == wxEVT_RIGHT_DOWN ||
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.type == wxEVT_LEFT_DOWN ||
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.type == wxEVT_MIDDLE_DOWN ||
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.type == wxEVT_MOTION )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( ClientToScreen(wxPoint(x, y)) == gs_lastMouseEvent.pos )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
gs_lastMouseEvent.type = wxEVT_MOTION;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MOUSEEVENT_HACK
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return HandleMouseEvent(WM_MOUSEMOVE, x, y, flags);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleMouseWheel(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_MOUSEWHEEL
|
|
|
|
// notice that WM_MOUSEWHEEL position is in screen coords (as it's
|
|
|
|
// forwarded up to the parent by DefWindowProc()) and not in the client
|
|
|
|
// ones as all the other messages, translate them to the client coords for
|
|
|
|
// consistency
|
|
|
|
const wxPoint
|
|
|
|
pt = ScreenToClient(wxPoint(GET_X_LPARAM(lParam), GET_Y_LPARAM(lParam)));
|
|
|
|
wxMouseEvent event(wxEVT_MOUSEWHEEL);
|
|
|
|
InitMouseEvent(event, pt.x, pt.y, LOWORD(wParam));
|
|
|
|
event.m_wheelRotation = (short)HIWORD(wParam);
|
|
|
|
event.m_wheelDelta = WHEEL_DELTA;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static int s_linesPerRotation = -1;
|
|
|
|
if ( s_linesPerRotation == -1 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( !::SystemParametersInfo(SPI_GETWHEELSCROLLLINES, 0,
|
|
|
|
&s_linesPerRotation, 0))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// this is not supposed to happen
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("SystemParametersInfo(GETWHEELSCROLLLINES)"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the default is 3, so use it if SystemParametersInfo() failed
|
|
|
|
s_linesPerRotation = 3;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.m_linesPerAction = s_linesPerRotation;
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#else // !wxUSE_MOUSEWHEEL
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(wParam);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_MOUSEWHEEL/!wxUSE_MOUSEWHEEL
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::GenerateMouseLeave()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
m_mouseInWindow = false;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int state = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ( wxIsShiftDown() )
|
|
|
|
state |= MK_SHIFT;
|
|
|
|
if ( wxIsCtrlDown() )
|
|
|
|
state |= MK_CONTROL;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Only the high-order bit should be tested
|
|
|
|
if ( GetKeyState( VK_LBUTTON ) & (1<<15) )
|
|
|
|
state |= MK_LBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
if ( GetKeyState( VK_MBUTTON ) & (1<<15) )
|
|
|
|
state |= MK_MBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
if ( GetKeyState( VK_RBUTTON ) & (1<<15) )
|
|
|
|
state |= MK_RBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetCursorPosWinCE(&pt) )
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetCursorPos(&pt) )
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("GetCursorPos"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we need to have client coordinates here for symmetry with
|
|
|
|
// wxEVT_ENTER_WINDOW
|
|
|
|
RECT rect = wxGetWindowRect(GetHwnd());
|
|
|
|
pt.x -= rect.left;
|
|
|
|
pt.y -= rect.top;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxMouseEvent event(wxEVT_LEAVE_WINDOW);
|
|
|
|
InitMouseEvent(event, pt.x, pt.y, state);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
(void)GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// keyboard handling
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// create the key event of the given type for the given key - used by
|
|
|
|
// HandleChar and HandleKeyDown/Up
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent wxWindowMSW::CreateKeyEvent(wxEventType evType,
|
|
|
|
int id,
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM lParam,
|
|
|
|
WXWPARAM wParam) const
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(evType);
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(GetId());
|
|
|
|
event.m_shiftDown = wxIsShiftDown();
|
|
|
|
event.m_controlDown = wxIsCtrlDown();
|
|
|
|
event.m_altDown = (HIWORD(lParam) & KF_ALTDOWN) == KF_ALTDOWN;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject((wxWindow *)this); // const_cast
|
|
|
|
event.m_keyCode = id;
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_UNICODE
|
|
|
|
event.m_uniChar = (wxChar) wParam;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
event.m_rawCode = (wxUint32) wParam;
|
|
|
|
event.m_rawFlags = (wxUint32) lParam;
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
event.SetTimestamp(::GetMessageTime());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// translate the position to client coords
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
GetCursorPosWinCE(&pt);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
GetCursorPos(&pt);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
RECT rect;
|
|
|
|
GetWindowRect(GetHwnd(),&rect);
|
|
|
|
pt.x -= rect.left;
|
|
|
|
pt.y -= rect.top;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.m_x = pt.x;
|
|
|
|
event.m_y = pt.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return event;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// isASCII is true only when we're called from WM_CHAR handler and not from
|
|
|
|
// WM_KEYDOWN one
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleChar(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam, bool isASCII)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int id;
|
|
|
|
if ( isASCII )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
id = wParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // we're called from WM_KEYDOWN
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// don't pass lParam to wxCharCodeMSWToWX() here because we don't want
|
|
|
|
// to get numpad key codes: CHAR events should use the logical keys
|
|
|
|
// such as WXK_HOME instead of WXK_NUMPAD_HOME which is for KEY events
|
|
|
|
id = wxCharCodeMSWToWX(wParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( id == 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it's ASCII and will be processed here only when called from
|
|
|
|
// WM_CHAR (i.e. when isASCII = true), don't process it now
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(CreateKeyEvent(wxEVT_CHAR, id, lParam, wParam));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the alphanumeric keys produced by pressing AltGr+something on European
|
|
|
|
// keyboards have both Ctrl and Alt modifiers which may confuse the user
|
|
|
|
// code as, normally, keys with Ctrl and/or Alt don't result in anything
|
|
|
|
// alphanumeric, so pretend that there are no modifiers at all (the
|
|
|
|
// KEY_DOWN event would still have the correct modifiers if they're really
|
|
|
|
// needed)
|
|
|
|
if ( event.m_controlDown && event.m_altDown &&
|
|
|
|
(id >= 32 && id < 256) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
event.m_controlDown =
|
|
|
|
event.m_altDown = false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleKeyDown(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int id = wxCharCodeMSWToWX(wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !id )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// normal ASCII char
|
|
|
|
id = wParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(CreateKeyEvent(wxEVT_KEY_DOWN, id, lParam, wParam));
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleKeyUp(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int id = wxCharCodeMSWToWX(wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !id )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// normal ASCII char
|
|
|
|
id = wParam;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(CreateKeyEvent(wxEVT_KEY_UP, id, lParam, wParam));
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int wxWindowMSW::HandleMenuChar(int WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(chAccel),
|
|
|
|
WXLPARAM WXUNUSED_IN_WINCE(lParam))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: implement GetMenuItemCount for WinCE, possibly
|
|
|
|
// in terms of GetMenuItemInfo
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
const HMENU hmenu = (HMENU)lParam;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
MENUITEMINFO mii;
|
|
|
|
wxZeroMemory(mii);
|
|
|
|
mii.cbSize = sizeof(MENUITEMINFO);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// we could use MIIM_FTYPE here as we only need to know if the item is
|
|
|
|
// ownerdrawn or not and not dwTypeData which MIIM_TYPE also returns, but
|
|
|
|
// MIIM_FTYPE is not supported under Win95
|
|
|
|
mii.fMask = MIIM_TYPE | MIIM_DATA;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// find if we have this letter in any owner drawn item
|
|
|
|
const int count = ::GetMenuItemCount(hmenu);
|
|
|
|
for ( int i = 0; i < count; i++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// previous loop iteration could modify it, reset it back before
|
|
|
|
// calling GetMenuItemInfo() to prevent it from overflowing dwTypeData
|
|
|
|
mii.cch = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( ::GetMenuItemInfo(hmenu, i, TRUE, &mii) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( mii.fType == MFT_OWNERDRAW )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// dwItemData member of the MENUITEMINFO is a
|
|
|
|
// pointer to the associated wxMenuItem -- see the
|
|
|
|
// menu creation code
|
|
|
|
wxMenuItem *item = (wxMenuItem*)mii.dwItemData;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const wxChar *p = wxStrchr(item->GetText(), _T('&'));
|
|
|
|
while ( p++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( *p == _T('&') )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// this is not the accel char, find the real one
|
|
|
|
p = wxStrchr(p + 1, _T('&'));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // got the accel char
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// FIXME-UNICODE: this comparison doesn't risk to work
|
|
|
|
// for non ASCII accelerator characters I'm afraid, but
|
|
|
|
// what can we do?
|
|
|
|
if ( (wchar_t)wxToupper(*p) == (wchar_t)chAccel )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return i;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// this one doesn't match
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // failed to get the menu text?
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it's not fatal, so don't show error, but still log it
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("GetMenuItemInfo"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
return wxNOT_FOUND;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleClipboardEvent( WXUINT nMsg )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
const wxEventType type = ( nMsg == WM_CUT ) ? wxEVT_COMMAND_TEXT_CUT :
|
|
|
|
( nMsg == WM_COPY ) ? wxEVT_COMMAND_TEXT_COPY :
|
|
|
|
/*( nMsg == WM_PASTE ) ? */ wxEVT_COMMAND_TEXT_PASTE;
|
|
|
|
wxClipboardTextEvent evt(type, GetId());
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
evt.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(evt);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// joystick
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleJoystickEvent(WXUINT msg, int x, int y, WXUINT flags)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#ifdef JOY_BUTTON1
|
|
|
|
int change = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON1CHG )
|
|
|
|
change = wxJOY_BUTTON1;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON2CHG )
|
|
|
|
change = wxJOY_BUTTON2;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON3CHG )
|
|
|
|
change = wxJOY_BUTTON3;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON4CHG )
|
|
|
|
change = wxJOY_BUTTON4;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int buttons = 0;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON1 )
|
|
|
|
buttons |= wxJOY_BUTTON1;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON2 )
|
|
|
|
buttons |= wxJOY_BUTTON2;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON3 )
|
|
|
|
buttons |= wxJOY_BUTTON3;
|
|
|
|
if ( flags & JOY_BUTTON4 )
|
|
|
|
buttons |= wxJOY_BUTTON4;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the event ids aren't consecutive so we can't use table based lookup
|
|
|
|
int joystick;
|
|
|
|
wxEventType eventType;
|
|
|
|
switch ( msg )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1MOVE:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 1;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_MOVE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2MOVE:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 2;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_MOVE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1ZMOVE:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 1;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_ZMOVE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2ZMOVE:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 2;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_ZMOVE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1BUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 1;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_BUTTON_DOWN;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2BUTTONDOWN:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 2;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_BUTTON_DOWN;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY1BUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 1;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_BUTTON_UP;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case MM_JOY2BUTTONUP:
|
|
|
|
joystick = 2;
|
|
|
|
eventType = wxEVT_JOY_BUTTON_UP;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
wxFAIL_MSG(wxT("no such joystick event"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxJoystickEvent event(eventType, buttons, joystick, change);
|
|
|
|
event.SetPosition(wxPoint(x, y));
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(msg);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(x);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(y);
|
|
|
|
wxUnusedVar(flags);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
// scrolling
|
|
|
|
// ---------------------------------------------------------------------------
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::MSWOnScroll(int orientation, WXWORD wParam,
|
|
|
|
WXWORD pos, WXHWND control)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( control && control != m_hWnd ) // Prevent infinite recursion
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *child = wxFindWinFromHandle(control);
|
|
|
|
if ( child )
|
|
|
|
return child->MSWOnScroll(orientation, wParam, pos, control);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxScrollWinEvent event;
|
|
|
|
event.SetPosition(pos);
|
|
|
|
event.SetOrientation(orientation);
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(this);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
switch ( wParam )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case SB_TOP:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_TOP);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_BOTTOM:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_BOTTOM);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_LINEUP:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEUP);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_LINEDOWN:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_LINEDOWN);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_PAGEUP:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEUP);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_PAGEDOWN:
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType(wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_PAGEDOWN);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case SB_THUMBPOSITION:
|
|
|
|
case SB_THUMBTRACK:
|
|
|
|
// under Win32, the scrollbar range and position are 32 bit integers,
|
|
|
|
// but WM_[HV]SCROLL only carry the low 16 bits of them, so we must
|
|
|
|
// explicitly query the scrollbar for the correct position (this must
|
|
|
|
// be done only for these two SB_ events as they are the only one
|
|
|
|
// carrying the scrollbar position)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
WinStruct<SCROLLINFO> scrollInfo;
|
|
|
|
scrollInfo.fMask = SIF_TRACKPOS;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !::GetScrollInfo(GetHwnd(),
|
|
|
|
orientation == wxHORIZONTAL ? SB_HORZ
|
|
|
|
: SB_VERT,
|
|
|
|
&scrollInfo) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Not necessarily an error, if there are no scrollbars yet.
|
|
|
|
// wxLogLastError(_T("GetScrollInfo"));
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.SetPosition(scrollInfo.nTrackPos);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventType( wParam == SB_THUMBPOSITION
|
|
|
|
? wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBRELEASE
|
|
|
|
: wxEVT_SCROLLWIN_THUMBTRACK );
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
// global functions
|
|
|
|
// ===========================================================================
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxGetCharSize(WXHWND wnd, int *x, int *y, const wxFont& the_font)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
TEXTMETRIC tm;
|
|
|
|
HDC dc = ::GetDC((HWND) wnd);
|
|
|
|
HFONT was = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the_font.UseResource();
|
|
|
|
// the_font.RealizeResource();
|
|
|
|
HFONT fnt = (HFONT)the_font.GetResourceHandle(); // const_cast
|
|
|
|
if ( fnt )
|
|
|
|
was = (HFONT) SelectObject(dc,fnt);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GetTextMetrics(dc, &tm);
|
|
|
|
if ( fnt && was )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
SelectObject(dc,was);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ReleaseDC((HWND)wnd, dc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( x )
|
|
|
|
*x = tm.tmAveCharWidth;
|
|
|
|
if ( y )
|
|
|
|
*y = tm.tmHeight + tm.tmExternalLeading;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// the_font.ReleaseResource();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// use the "extended" bit (24) of lParam to distinguish extended keys
|
|
|
|
// from normal keys as the same key is sent
|
|
|
|
static inline
|
|
|
|
int ChooseNormalOrExtended(int lParam, int keyNormal, int keyExtended)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// except that if lParam is 0, it means we don't have real lParam from
|
|
|
|
// WM_KEYDOWN but are just translating just a VK constant (e.g. done from
|
|
|
|
// msw/treectrl.cpp when processing TVN_KEYDOWN) -- then assume this is a
|
|
|
|
// non-numpad (hence extended) key as this is a more common case
|
|
|
|
return !lParam || (lParam & (1 << 24)) ? keyExtended : keyNormal;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// this array contains the Windows virtual key codes which map one to one to
|
|
|
|
// WXK_xxx constants and is used in wxCharCodeMSWToWX/WXToMSW() below
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// note that keys having a normal and numpad version (e.g. WXK_HOME and
|
|
|
|
// WXK_NUMPAD_HOME) are not included in this table as the mapping is not 1-to-1
|
|
|
|
static const struct wxKeyMapping
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int vk;
|
|
|
|
wxKeyCode wxk;
|
|
|
|
} gs_specialKeys[] =
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
{ VK_CANCEL, WXK_CANCEL },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_BACK, WXK_BACK },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_TAB, WXK_TAB },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_CLEAR, WXK_CLEAR },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SHIFT, WXK_SHIFT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_CONTROL, WXK_CONTROL },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_MENU , WXK_ALT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_PAUSE, WXK_PAUSE },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_CAPITAL, WXK_CAPITAL },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SPACE, WXK_SPACE },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_ESCAPE, WXK_ESCAPE },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SELECT, WXK_SELECT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_PRINT, WXK_PRINT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_EXECUTE, WXK_EXECUTE },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SNAPSHOT, WXK_SNAPSHOT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_HELP, WXK_HELP },
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD0, WXK_NUMPAD0 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD1, WXK_NUMPAD1 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD2, WXK_NUMPAD2 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD3, WXK_NUMPAD3 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD4, WXK_NUMPAD4 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD5, WXK_NUMPAD5 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD6, WXK_NUMPAD6 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD7, WXK_NUMPAD7 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD8, WXK_NUMPAD8 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMPAD9, WXK_NUMPAD9 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_MULTIPLY, WXK_NUMPAD_MULTIPLY },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_ADD, WXK_NUMPAD_ADD },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SUBTRACT, WXK_NUMPAD_SUBTRACT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_DECIMAL, WXK_NUMPAD_DECIMAL },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_DIVIDE, WXK_NUMPAD_DIVIDE },
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F1, WXK_F1 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F2, WXK_F2 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F3, WXK_F3 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F4, WXK_F4 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F5, WXK_F5 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F6, WXK_F6 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F7, WXK_F7 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F8, WXK_F8 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F9, WXK_F9 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F10, WXK_F10 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F11, WXK_F11 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F12, WXK_F12 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F13, WXK_F13 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F14, WXK_F14 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F15, WXK_F15 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F16, WXK_F16 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F17, WXK_F17 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F18, WXK_F18 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F19, WXK_F19 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F20, WXK_F20 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F21, WXK_F21 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F22, WXK_F22 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F23, WXK_F23 },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_F24, WXK_F24 },
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
{ VK_NUMLOCK, WXK_NUMLOCK },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_SCROLL, WXK_SCROLL },
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef VK_APPS
|
|
|
|
{ VK_LWIN, WXK_WINDOWS_LEFT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_RWIN, WXK_WINDOWS_RIGHT },
|
|
|
|
{ VK_APPS, WXK_WINDOWS_MENU },
|
|
|
|
#endif // VK_APPS defined
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Returns 0 if was a normal ASCII value, not a special key. This indicates that
|
|
|
|
// the key should be ignored by WM_KEYDOWN and processed by WM_CHAR instead.
|
|
|
|
int wxCharCodeMSWToWX(int vk, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// check the table first
|
|
|
|
for ( size_t n = 0; n < WXSIZEOF(gs_specialKeys); n++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( gs_specialKeys[n].vk == vk )
|
|
|
|
return gs_specialKeys[n].wxk;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// keys requiring special handling
|
|
|
|
int wxk;
|
|
|
|
switch ( vk )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// the mapping for these keys may be incorrect on non-US keyboards so
|
|
|
|
// maybe we shouldn't map them to ASCII values at all
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_1: wxk = ';'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_PLUS: wxk = '+'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_COMMA: wxk = ','; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_MINUS: wxk = '-'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_PERIOD: wxk = '.'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_2: wxk = '/'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_3: wxk = '~'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_4: wxk = '['; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_5: wxk = '\\'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_6: wxk = ']'; break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_OEM_7: wxk = '\''; break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// handle extended keys
|
|
|
|
case VK_PRIOR:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEUP, WXK_PAGEUP);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_NEXT:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEDOWN, WXK_PAGEDOWN);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_END:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_END, WXK_END);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_HOME:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_HOME, WXK_HOME);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_LEFT:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_LEFT, WXK_LEFT);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_UP:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_UP, WXK_UP);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_RIGHT:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_RIGHT, WXK_RIGHT);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_DOWN:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_DOWN, WXK_DOWN);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_INSERT:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_INSERT, WXK_INSERT);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_DELETE:
|
|
|
|
wxk = ChooseNormalOrExtended(lParam, WXK_NUMPAD_DELETE, WXK_DELETE);
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case VK_RETURN:
|
|
|
|
// don't use ChooseNormalOrExtended() here as the keys are reversed
|
|
|
|
// here: numpad enter is the extended one
|
|
|
|
wxk = lParam && (lParam & (1 << 24)) ? WXK_NUMPAD_ENTER : WXK_RETURN;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
wxk = 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return wxk;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
WXWORD wxCharCodeWXToMSW(int wxk, bool *isVirtual)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( isVirtual )
|
|
|
|
*isVirtual = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// check the table first
|
|
|
|
for ( size_t n = 0; n < WXSIZEOF(gs_specialKeys); n++ )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( gs_specialKeys[n].wxk == wxk )
|
|
|
|
return gs_specialKeys[n].vk;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// and then check for special keys not included in the table
|
|
|
|
WXWORD vk;
|
|
|
|
switch ( wxk )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case WXK_PAGEUP:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEUP:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_PRIOR;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_PAGEDOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_PAGEDOWN:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_NEXT;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_END:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_END:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_END;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_HOME:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_HOME:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_HOME;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_LEFT:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_LEFT:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_LEFT;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_UP:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_UP:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_UP;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_RIGHT:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_RIGHT:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_RIGHT;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_DOWN:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_DOWN:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_DOWN;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_INSERT:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_INSERT:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_INSERT;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case WXK_DELETE:
|
|
|
|
case WXK_NUMPAD_DELETE:
|
|
|
|
vk = VK_DELETE;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
// check to see if its one of the OEM key codes.
|
|
|
|
BYTE vks = LOBYTE(VkKeyScan(wxk));
|
|
|
|
if ( vks != 0xff )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
vk = vks;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( isVirtual )
|
|
|
|
*isVirtual = false;
|
|
|
|
vk = (WXWORD)wxk;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return vk;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifndef SM_SWAPBUTTON
|
|
|
|
#define SM_SWAPBUTTON 23
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// small helper for wxGetKeyState() and wxGetMouseState()
|
|
|
|
static inline bool wxIsKeyDown(WXWORD vk)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
switch (vk)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case VK_LBUTTON:
|
|
|
|
if (GetSystemMetrics(SM_SWAPBUTTON)) vk = VK_RBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case VK_RBUTTON:
|
|
|
|
if (GetSystemMetrics(SM_SWAPBUTTON)) vk = VK_LBUTTON;
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// the low order bit indicates whether the key was pressed since the last
|
|
|
|
// call and the high order one indicates whether it is down right now and
|
|
|
|
// we only want that one
|
|
|
|
return (GetAsyncKeyState(vk) & (1<<15)) != 0;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxGetKeyState(wxKeyCode key)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// although this does work under Windows, it is not supported under other
|
|
|
|
// platforms so don't allow it, you must use wxGetMouseState() instead
|
|
|
|
wxASSERT_MSG( key != VK_LBUTTON &&
|
|
|
|
key != VK_RBUTTON &&
|
|
|
|
key != VK_MBUTTON,
|
|
|
|
wxT("can't use wxGetKeyState() for mouse buttons") );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
const WXWORD vk = wxCharCodeWXToMSW(key);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// if the requested key is a LED key, return true if the led is pressed
|
|
|
|
if ( key == WXK_NUMLOCK || key == WXK_CAPITAL || key == WXK_SCROLL )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// low order bit means LED is highlighted and high order one means the
|
|
|
|
// key is down; for compatibility with the other ports return true if
|
|
|
|
// either one is set
|
|
|
|
return GetKeyState(vk) != 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else // normal key
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return wxIsKeyDown(vk);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxMouseState wxGetMouseState()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxMouseState ms;
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
GetCursorPos( &pt );
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ms.SetX(pt.x);
|
|
|
|
ms.SetY(pt.y);
|
|
|
|
ms.SetLeftDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_LBUTTON));
|
|
|
|
ms.SetMiddleDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_MBUTTON));
|
|
|
|
ms.SetRightDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_RBUTTON));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
ms.SetControlDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_CONTROL));
|
|
|
|
ms.SetShiftDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_SHIFT));
|
|
|
|
ms.SetAltDown(wxIsKeyDown(VK_MENU));
|
|
|
|
// ms.SetMetaDown();
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return ms;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *wxGetActiveWindow()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = GetActiveWindow();
|
|
|
|
if ( hWnd != 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
return wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND) hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return NULL;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
extern wxWindow *wxGetWindowFromHWND(WXHWND hWnd)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = (HWND)hWnd;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// For a radiobutton, we get the radiobox from GWL_USERDATA (which is set
|
|
|
|
// by code in msw/radiobox.cpp), for all the others we just search up the
|
|
|
|
// window hierarchy
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = (wxWindow *)NULL;
|
|
|
|
if ( hwnd )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)hwnd);
|
|
|
|
if ( !win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_RADIOBOX
|
|
|
|
// native radiobuttons return DLGC_RADIOBUTTON here and for any
|
|
|
|
// wxWindow class which overrides WM_GETDLGCODE processing to
|
|
|
|
// do it as well, win would be already non NULL
|
|
|
|
if ( ::SendMessage(hwnd, WM_GETDLGCODE, 0, 0) & DLGC_RADIOBUTTON )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = (wxWindow *)wxGetWindowUserData(hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
//else: it's a wxRadioButton, not a radiobutton from wxRadioBox
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_RADIOBOX
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// spin control text buddy window should be mapped to spin ctrl
|
|
|
|
// itself so try it too
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_SPINCTRL && !defined(__WXUNIVERSAL__)
|
|
|
|
if ( !win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
win = wxSpinCtrl::GetSpinForTextCtrl((WXHWND)hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_SPINCTRL
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
while ( hwnd && !win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// this is a really ugly hack needed to avoid mistakenly returning the
|
|
|
|
// parent frame wxWindow for the find/replace modeless dialog HWND -
|
|
|
|
// this, in turn, is needed to call IsDialogMessage() from
|
|
|
|
// wxApp::ProcessMessage() as for this we must return NULL from here
|
|
|
|
//
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: this is clearly not the best way to do it but I think we'll
|
|
|
|
// need to change HWND <-> wxWindow code more heavily than I can
|
|
|
|
// do it now to fix it
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
if ( ::GetWindow(hwnd, GW_OWNER) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// it's a dialog box, don't go upwards
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
hwnd = ::GetParent(hwnd);
|
|
|
|
win = wxFindWinFromHandle((WXHWND)hwnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return win;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !defined(__WXMICROWIN__) && !defined(__WXWINCE__)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Windows keyboard hook. Allows interception of e.g. F1, ESCAPE
|
|
|
|
// in active frames and dialogs, regardless of where the focus is.
|
|
|
|
static HHOOK wxTheKeyboardHook = 0;
|
|
|
|
static FARPROC wxTheKeyboardHookProc = 0;
|
|
|
|
int APIENTRY _EXPORT
|
|
|
|
wxKeyboardHook(int nCode, WORD wParam, DWORD lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
void wxSetKeyboardHook(bool doIt)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if ( doIt )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxTheKeyboardHookProc = MakeProcInstance((FARPROC) wxKeyboardHook, wxGetInstance());
|
|
|
|
wxTheKeyboardHook = SetWindowsHookEx(WH_KEYBOARD, (HOOKPROC) wxTheKeyboardHookProc, wxGetInstance(),
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
GetCurrentThreadId()
|
|
|
|
// (DWORD)GetCurrentProcess()); // This is another possibility. Which is right?
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
UnhookWindowsHookEx(wxTheKeyboardHook);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
int APIENTRY _EXPORT
|
|
|
|
wxKeyboardHook(int nCode, WORD wParam, DWORD lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
DWORD hiWord = HIWORD(lParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( nCode != HC_NOREMOVE && ((hiWord & KF_UP) == 0) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int id = wxCharCodeMSWToWX(wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
if ( id != 0 )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(wxEVT_CHAR_HOOK);
|
|
|
|
if ( (HIWORD(lParam) & KF_ALTDOWN) == KF_ALTDOWN )
|
|
|
|
event.m_altDown = true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.SetEventObject(NULL);
|
|
|
|
event.m_keyCode = id;
|
|
|
|
event.m_shiftDown = wxIsShiftDown();
|
|
|
|
event.m_controlDown = wxIsCtrlDown();
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
event.SetTimestamp(::GetMessageTime());
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *win = wxGetActiveWindow();
|
|
|
|
wxEvtHandler *handler;
|
|
|
|
if ( win )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
handler = win->GetEventHandler();
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(win->GetId());
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
else
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
handler = wxTheApp;
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(wxID_ANY);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( handler && handler->ProcessEvent(event) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// processed
|
|
|
|
return 1;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return (int)CallNextHookEx(wxTheKeyboardHook, nCode, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // !__WXMICROWIN__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
const wxChar *wxGetMessageName(int message)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
switch ( message )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
case 0x0000: return wxT("WM_NULL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0001: return wxT("WM_CREATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0002: return wxT("WM_DESTROY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0003: return wxT("WM_MOVE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0005: return wxT("WM_SIZE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0006: return wxT("WM_ACTIVATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0007: return wxT("WM_SETFOCUS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0008: return wxT("WM_KILLFOCUS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000A: return wxT("WM_ENABLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000B: return wxT("WM_SETREDRAW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000C: return wxT("WM_SETTEXT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000D: return wxT("WM_GETTEXT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000E: return wxT("WM_GETTEXTLENGTH");
|
|
|
|
case 0x000F: return wxT("WM_PAINT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0010: return wxT("WM_CLOSE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0011: return wxT("WM_QUERYENDSESSION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0012: return wxT("WM_QUIT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0013: return wxT("WM_QUERYOPEN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0014: return wxT("WM_ERASEBKGND");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0015: return wxT("WM_SYSCOLORCHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0016: return wxT("WM_ENDSESSION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0017: return wxT("WM_SYSTEMERROR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0018: return wxT("WM_SHOWWINDOW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0019: return wxT("WM_CTLCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001A: return wxT("WM_WININICHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001B: return wxT("WM_DEVMODECHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001C: return wxT("WM_ACTIVATEAPP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001D: return wxT("WM_FONTCHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001E: return wxT("WM_TIMECHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x001F: return wxT("WM_CANCELMODE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0020: return wxT("WM_SETCURSOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0021: return wxT("WM_MOUSEACTIVATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0022: return wxT("WM_CHILDACTIVATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0023: return wxT("WM_QUEUESYNC");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0024: return wxT("WM_GETMINMAXINFO");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0026: return wxT("WM_PAINTICON");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0027: return wxT("WM_ICONERASEBKGND");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0028: return wxT("WM_NEXTDLGCTL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002A: return wxT("WM_SPOOLERSTATUS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002B: return wxT("WM_DRAWITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002C: return wxT("WM_MEASUREITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002D: return wxT("WM_DELETEITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002E: return wxT("WM_VKEYTOITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x002F: return wxT("WM_CHARTOITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0030: return wxT("WM_SETFONT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0031: return wxT("WM_GETFONT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0037: return wxT("WM_QUERYDRAGICON");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0039: return wxT("WM_COMPAREITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0041: return wxT("WM_COMPACTING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0044: return wxT("WM_COMMNOTIFY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0046: return wxT("WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0047: return wxT("WM_WINDOWPOSCHANGED");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0048: return wxT("WM_POWER");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x004A: return wxT("WM_COPYDATA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x004B: return wxT("WM_CANCELJOURNAL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x004E: return wxT("WM_NOTIFY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0050: return wxT("WM_INPUTLANGCHANGEREQUEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0051: return wxT("WM_INPUTLANGCHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0052: return wxT("WM_TCARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0053: return wxT("WM_HELP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0054: return wxT("WM_USERCHANGED");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0055: return wxT("WM_NOTIFYFORMAT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x007B: return wxT("WM_CONTEXTMENU");
|
|
|
|
case 0x007C: return wxT("WM_STYLECHANGING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x007D: return wxT("WM_STYLECHANGED");
|
|
|
|
case 0x007E: return wxT("WM_DISPLAYCHANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x007F: return wxT("WM_GETICON");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0080: return wxT("WM_SETICON");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0081: return wxT("WM_NCCREATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0082: return wxT("WM_NCDESTROY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0083: return wxT("WM_NCCALCSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0084: return wxT("WM_NCHITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0085: return wxT("WM_NCPAINT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0086: return wxT("WM_NCACTIVATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0087: return wxT("WM_GETDLGCODE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A0: return wxT("WM_NCMOUSEMOVE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A1: return wxT("WM_NCLBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A2: return wxT("WM_NCLBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A3: return wxT("WM_NCLBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A4: return wxT("WM_NCRBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A5: return wxT("WM_NCRBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A6: return wxT("WM_NCRBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A7: return wxT("WM_NCMBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A8: return wxT("WM_NCMBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x00A9: return wxT("WM_NCMBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0100: return wxT("WM_KEYDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0101: return wxT("WM_KEYUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0102: return wxT("WM_CHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0103: return wxT("WM_DEADCHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0104: return wxT("WM_SYSKEYDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0105: return wxT("WM_SYSKEYUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0106: return wxT("WM_SYSCHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0107: return wxT("WM_SYSDEADCHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0108: return wxT("WM_KEYLAST");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x010D: return wxT("WM_IME_STARTCOMPOSITION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x010E: return wxT("WM_IME_ENDCOMPOSITION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x010F: return wxT("WM_IME_COMPOSITION");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0110: return wxT("WM_INITDIALOG");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0111: return wxT("WM_COMMAND");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0112: return wxT("WM_SYSCOMMAND");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0113: return wxT("WM_TIMER");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0114: return wxT("WM_HSCROLL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0115: return wxT("WM_VSCROLL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0116: return wxT("WM_INITMENU");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0117: return wxT("WM_INITMENUPOPUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x011F: return wxT("WM_MENUSELECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0120: return wxT("WM_MENUCHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0121: return wxT("WM_ENTERIDLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0200: return wxT("WM_MOUSEMOVE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0201: return wxT("WM_LBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0202: return wxT("WM_LBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0203: return wxT("WM_LBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0204: return wxT("WM_RBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0205: return wxT("WM_RBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0206: return wxT("WM_RBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0207: return wxT("WM_MBUTTONDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0208: return wxT("WM_MBUTTONUP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0209: return wxT("WM_MBUTTONDBLCLK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x020A: return wxT("WM_MOUSEWHEEL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0210: return wxT("WM_PARENTNOTIFY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0211: return wxT("WM_ENTERMENULOOP");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0212: return wxT("WM_EXITMENULOOP");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0213: return wxT("WM_NEXTMENU");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0214: return wxT("WM_SIZING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0215: return wxT("WM_CAPTURECHANGED");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0216: return wxT("WM_MOVING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0218: return wxT("WM_POWERBROADCAST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0219: return wxT("WM_DEVICECHANGE");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0220: return wxT("WM_MDICREATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0221: return wxT("WM_MDIDESTROY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0222: return wxT("WM_MDIACTIVATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0223: return wxT("WM_MDIRESTORE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0224: return wxT("WM_MDINEXT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0225: return wxT("WM_MDIMAXIMIZE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0226: return wxT("WM_MDITILE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0227: return wxT("WM_MDICASCADE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0228: return wxT("WM_MDIICONARRANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0229: return wxT("WM_MDIGETACTIVE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0230: return wxT("WM_MDISETMENU");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0233: return wxT("WM_DROPFILES");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0281: return wxT("WM_IME_SETCONTEXT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0282: return wxT("WM_IME_NOTIFY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0283: return wxT("WM_IME_CONTROL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0284: return wxT("WM_IME_COMPOSITIONFULL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0285: return wxT("WM_IME_SELECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0286: return wxT("WM_IME_CHAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0290: return wxT("WM_IME_KEYDOWN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0291: return wxT("WM_IME_KEYUP");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
case 0x0300: return wxT("WM_CUT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0301: return wxT("WM_COPY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0302: return wxT("WM_PASTE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0303: return wxT("WM_CLEAR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0304: return wxT("WM_UNDO");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0305: return wxT("WM_RENDERFORMAT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0306: return wxT("WM_RENDERALLFORMATS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0307: return wxT("WM_DESTROYCLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0308: return wxT("WM_DRAWCLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0309: return wxT("WM_PAINTCLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030A: return wxT("WM_VSCROLLCLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030B: return wxT("WM_SIZECLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030C: return wxT("WM_ASKCBFORMATNAME");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030D: return wxT("WM_CHANGECBCHAIN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030E: return wxT("WM_HSCROLLCLIPBOARD");
|
|
|
|
case 0x030F: return wxT("WM_QUERYNEWPALETTE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0310: return wxT("WM_PALETTEISCHANGING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x0311: return wxT("WM_PALETTECHANGED");
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_HOTKEY
|
|
|
|
case 0x0312: return wxT("WM_HOTKEY");
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// common controls messages - although they're not strictly speaking
|
|
|
|
// standard, it's nice to decode them nevertheless
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// listview
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 0: return wxT("LVM_GETBKCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 1: return wxT("LVM_SETBKCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 2: return wxT("LVM_GETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 3: return wxT("LVM_SETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 4: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 5: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 75: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 6: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 76: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 7: return wxT("LVM_INSERTITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 77: return wxT("LVM_INSERTITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 8: return wxT("LVM_DELETEITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 9: return wxT("LVM_DELETEALLITEMS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 10: return wxT("LVM_GETCALLBACKMASK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 11: return wxT("LVM_SETCALLBACKMASK");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 12: return wxT("LVM_GETNEXTITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 13: return wxT("LVM_FINDITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 83: return wxT("LVM_FINDITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 14: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 15: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMPOSITION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 16: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMPOSITION");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 17: return wxT("LVM_GETSTRINGWIDTHA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 87: return wxT("LVM_GETSTRINGWIDTHW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 18: return wxT("LVM_HITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 19: return wxT("LVM_ENSUREVISIBLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 20: return wxT("LVM_SCROLL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 21: return wxT("LVM_REDRAWITEMS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 22: return wxT("LVM_ARRANGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 23: return wxT("LVM_EDITLABELA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 118: return wxT("LVM_EDITLABELW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 24: return wxT("LVM_GETEDITCONTROL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 25: return wxT("LVM_GETCOLUMNA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 95: return wxT("LVM_GETCOLUMNW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 26: return wxT("LVM_SETCOLUMNA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 96: return wxT("LVM_SETCOLUMNW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 27: return wxT("LVM_INSERTCOLUMNA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 97: return wxT("LVM_INSERTCOLUMNW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 28: return wxT("LVM_DELETECOLUMN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 29: return wxT("LVM_GETCOLUMNWIDTH");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 30: return wxT("LVM_SETCOLUMNWIDTH");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 31: return wxT("LVM_GETHEADER");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 33: return wxT("LVM_CREATEDRAGIMAGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 34: return wxT("LVM_GETVIEWRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 35: return wxT("LVM_GETTEXTCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 36: return wxT("LVM_SETTEXTCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 37: return wxT("LVM_GETTEXTBKCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 38: return wxT("LVM_SETTEXTBKCOLOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 39: return wxT("LVM_GETTOPINDEX");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 40: return wxT("LVM_GETCOUNTPERPAGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 41: return wxT("LVM_GETORIGIN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 42: return wxT("LVM_UPDATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 43: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMSTATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 44: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMSTATE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 45: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMTEXTA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 115: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMTEXTW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 46: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMTEXTA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 116: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMTEXTW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 47: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 48: return wxT("LVM_SORTITEMS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 49: return wxT("LVM_SETITEMPOSITION32");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 50: return wxT("LVM_GETSELECTEDCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 51: return wxT("LVM_GETITEMSPACING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 52: return wxT("LVM_GETISEARCHSTRINGA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 117: return wxT("LVM_GETISEARCHSTRINGW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 53: return wxT("LVM_SETICONSPACING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 54: return wxT("LVM_SETEXTENDEDLISTVIEWSTYLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 55: return wxT("LVM_GETEXTENDEDLISTVIEWSTYLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 56: return wxT("LVM_GETSUBITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 57: return wxT("LVM_SUBITEMHITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 58: return wxT("LVM_SETCOLUMNORDERARRAY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 59: return wxT("LVM_GETCOLUMNORDERARRAY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 60: return wxT("LVM_SETHOTITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 61: return wxT("LVM_GETHOTITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 62: return wxT("LVM_SETHOTCURSOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 63: return wxT("LVM_GETHOTCURSOR");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 64: return wxT("LVM_APPROXIMATEVIEWRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1000 + 65: return wxT("LVM_SETWORKAREA");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// tree view
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 0: return wxT("TVM_INSERTITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 50: return wxT("TVM_INSERTITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 1: return wxT("TVM_DELETEITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 2: return wxT("TVM_EXPAND");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 4: return wxT("TVM_GETITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 5: return wxT("TVM_GETCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 6: return wxT("TVM_GETINDENT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 7: return wxT("TVM_SETINDENT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 8: return wxT("TVM_GETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 9: return wxT("TVM_SETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 10: return wxT("TVM_GETNEXTITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 11: return wxT("TVM_SELECTITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 12: return wxT("TVM_GETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 62: return wxT("TVM_GETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 13: return wxT("TVM_SETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 63: return wxT("TVM_SETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 14: return wxT("TVM_EDITLABELA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 65: return wxT("TVM_EDITLABELW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 15: return wxT("TVM_GETEDITCONTROL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 16: return wxT("TVM_GETVISIBLECOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 17: return wxT("TVM_HITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 18: return wxT("TVM_CREATEDRAGIMAGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 19: return wxT("TVM_SORTCHILDREN");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 20: return wxT("TVM_ENSUREVISIBLE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 21: return wxT("TVM_SORTCHILDRENCB");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 22: return wxT("TVM_ENDEDITLABELNOW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 23: return wxT("TVM_GETISEARCHSTRINGA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 64: return wxT("TVM_GETISEARCHSTRINGW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 24: return wxT("TVM_SETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1100 + 25: return wxT("TVM_GETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// header
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 0: return wxT("HDM_GETITEMCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 1: return wxT("HDM_INSERTITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 10: return wxT("HDM_INSERTITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 2: return wxT("HDM_DELETEITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 3: return wxT("HDM_GETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 11: return wxT("HDM_GETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 4: return wxT("HDM_SETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 12: return wxT("HDM_SETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 5: return wxT("HDM_LAYOUT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 6: return wxT("HDM_HITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 7: return wxT("HDM_GETITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 8: return wxT("HDM_SETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 9: return wxT("HDM_GETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 15: return wxT("HDM_ORDERTOINDEX");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 16: return wxT("HDM_CREATEDRAGIMAGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 17: return wxT("HDM_GETORDERARRAY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 18: return wxT("HDM_SETORDERARRAY");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1200 + 19: return wxT("HDM_SETHOTDIVIDER");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// tab control
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 2: return wxT("TCM_GETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 3: return wxT("TCM_SETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 4: return wxT("TCM_GETITEMCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 5: return wxT("TCM_GETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 60: return wxT("TCM_GETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 6: return wxT("TCM_SETITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 61: return wxT("TCM_SETITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 7: return wxT("TCM_INSERTITEMA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 62: return wxT("TCM_INSERTITEMW");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 8: return wxT("TCM_DELETEITEM");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 9: return wxT("TCM_DELETEALLITEMS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 10: return wxT("TCM_GETITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 11: return wxT("TCM_GETCURSEL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 12: return wxT("TCM_SETCURSEL");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 13: return wxT("TCM_HITTEST");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 14: return wxT("TCM_SETITEMEXTRA");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 40: return wxT("TCM_ADJUSTRECT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 41: return wxT("TCM_SETITEMSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 42: return wxT("TCM_REMOVEIMAGE");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 43: return wxT("TCM_SETPADDING");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 44: return wxT("TCM_GETROWCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 45: return wxT("TCM_GETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 46: return wxT("TCM_SETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 47: return wxT("TCM_GETCURFOCUS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 48: return wxT("TCM_SETCURFOCUS");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 49: return wxT("TCM_SETMINTABWIDTH");
|
|
|
|
case 0x1300 + 50: return wxT("TCM_DESELECTALL");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// toolbar
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+1: return wxT("TB_ENABLEBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+2: return wxT("TB_CHECKBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+3: return wxT("TB_PRESSBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+4: return wxT("TB_HIDEBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+5: return wxT("TB_INDETERMINATE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+9: return wxT("TB_ISBUTTONENABLED");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+10: return wxT("TB_ISBUTTONCHECKED");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+11: return wxT("TB_ISBUTTONPRESSED");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+12: return wxT("TB_ISBUTTONHIDDEN");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+13: return wxT("TB_ISBUTTONINDETERMINATE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+17: return wxT("TB_SETSTATE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+18: return wxT("TB_GETSTATE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+19: return wxT("TB_ADDBITMAP");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+20: return wxT("TB_ADDBUTTONS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+21: return wxT("TB_INSERTBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+22: return wxT("TB_DELETEBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+23: return wxT("TB_GETBUTTON");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+24: return wxT("TB_BUTTONCOUNT");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+25: return wxT("TB_COMMANDTOINDEX");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+26: return wxT("TB_SAVERESTOREA");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+76: return wxT("TB_SAVERESTOREW");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+27: return wxT("TB_CUSTOMIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+28: return wxT("TB_ADDSTRINGA");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+77: return wxT("TB_ADDSTRINGW");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+29: return wxT("TB_GETITEMRECT");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+30: return wxT("TB_BUTTONSTRUCTSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+31: return wxT("TB_SETBUTTONSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+32: return wxT("TB_SETBITMAPSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+33: return wxT("TB_AUTOSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+35: return wxT("TB_GETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+36: return wxT("TB_SETTOOLTIPS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+37: return wxT("TB_SETPARENT");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+39: return wxT("TB_SETROWS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+40: return wxT("TB_GETROWS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+42: return wxT("TB_SETCMDID");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+43: return wxT("TB_CHANGEBITMAP");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+44: return wxT("TB_GETBITMAP");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+45: return wxT("TB_GETBUTTONTEXTA");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+75: return wxT("TB_GETBUTTONTEXTW");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+46: return wxT("TB_REPLACEBITMAP");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+47: return wxT("TB_SETINDENT");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+48: return wxT("TB_SETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+49: return wxT("TB_GETIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+50: return wxT("TB_LOADIMAGES");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+51: return wxT("TB_GETRECT");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+52: return wxT("TB_SETHOTIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+53: return wxT("TB_GETHOTIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+54: return wxT("TB_SETDISABLEDIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+55: return wxT("TB_GETDISABLEDIMAGELIST");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+56: return wxT("TB_SETSTYLE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+57: return wxT("TB_GETSTYLE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+58: return wxT("TB_GETBUTTONSIZE");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+59: return wxT("TB_SETBUTTONWIDTH");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+60: return wxT("TB_SETMAXTEXTROWS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+61: return wxT("TB_GETTEXTROWS");
|
|
|
|
case WM_USER+41: return wxT("TB_GETBITMAPFLAGS");
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
default:
|
|
|
|
static wxString s_szBuf;
|
|
|
|
s_szBuf.Printf(wxT("<unknown message = %d>"), message);
|
|
|
|
return s_szBuf.c_str();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif //__WXDEBUG__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static TEXTMETRIC wxGetTextMetrics(const wxWindowMSW *win)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// prepare the DC
|
|
|
|
TEXTMETRIC tm;
|
|
|
|
HWND hwnd = GetHwndOf(win);
|
|
|
|
HDC hdc = ::GetDC(hwnd);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !wxDIALOG_UNIT_COMPATIBILITY
|
|
|
|
// and select the current font into it
|
|
|
|
HFONT hfont = GetHfontOf(win->GetFont());
|
|
|
|
if ( hfont )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
hfont = (HFONT)::SelectObject(hdc, hfont);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// finally retrieve the text metrics from it
|
|
|
|
GetTextMetrics(hdc, &tm);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if !wxDIALOG_UNIT_COMPATIBILITY
|
|
|
|
// and clean up
|
|
|
|
if ( hfont )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
(void)::SelectObject(hdc, hfont);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
::ReleaseDC(hwnd, hdc);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return tm;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Find the wxWindow at the current mouse position, returning the mouse
|
|
|
|
// position.
|
|
|
|
wxWindow* wxFindWindowAtPointer(wxPoint& pt)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
pt = wxGetMousePosition();
|
|
|
|
return wxFindWindowAtPoint(pt);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindow* wxFindWindowAtPoint(const wxPoint& pt)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
POINT pt2;
|
|
|
|
pt2.x = pt.x;
|
|
|
|
pt2.y = pt.y;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HWND hWnd = ::WindowFromPoint(pt2);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return wxGetWindowFromHWND((WXHWND)hWnd);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Get the current mouse position.
|
|
|
|
wxPoint wxGetMousePosition()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
POINT pt;
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
GetCursorPosWinCE(&pt);
|
|
|
|
#else
|
|
|
|
GetCursorPos( & pt );
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return wxPoint(pt.x, pt.y);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_HOTKEY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__SMARTPHONE__) || defined(__POCKETPC__)
|
|
|
|
static void WinCEUnregisterHotKey(int modifiers, int id)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Register hotkeys for the hardware buttons
|
|
|
|
HINSTANCE hCoreDll;
|
|
|
|
typedef BOOL (WINAPI *UnregisterFunc1Proc)(UINT, UINT);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
UnregisterFunc1Proc procUnregisterFunc;
|
|
|
|
hCoreDll = LoadLibrary(_T("coredll.dll"));
|
|
|
|
if (hCoreDll)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
procUnregisterFunc = (UnregisterFunc1Proc)GetProcAddress(hCoreDll, _T("UnregisterFunc1"));
|
|
|
|
if (procUnregisterFunc)
|
|
|
|
procUnregisterFunc(modifiers, id);
|
|
|
|
FreeLibrary(hCoreDll);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::RegisterHotKey(int hotkeyId, int modifiers, int keycode)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
UINT win_modifiers=0;
|
|
|
|
if ( modifiers & wxMOD_ALT )
|
|
|
|
win_modifiers |= MOD_ALT;
|
|
|
|
if ( modifiers & wxMOD_SHIFT )
|
|
|
|
win_modifiers |= MOD_SHIFT;
|
|
|
|
if ( modifiers & wxMOD_CONTROL )
|
|
|
|
win_modifiers |= MOD_CONTROL;
|
|
|
|
if ( modifiers & wxMOD_WIN )
|
|
|
|
win_modifiers |= MOD_WIN;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__SMARTPHONE__) || defined(__POCKETPC__)
|
|
|
|
// Required for PPC and Smartphone hardware buttons
|
|
|
|
if (keycode >= WXK_SPECIAL1 && keycode <= WXK_SPECIAL20)
|
|
|
|
WinCEUnregisterHotKey(win_modifiers, hotkeyId);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !::RegisterHotKey(GetHwnd(), hotkeyId, win_modifiers, keycode) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("RegisterHotKey"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::UnregisterHotKey(int hotkeyId)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if defined(__SMARTPHONE__) || defined(__POCKETPC__)
|
|
|
|
WinCEUnregisterHotKey(MOD_WIN, hotkeyId);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !::UnregisterHotKey(GetHwnd(), hotkeyId) )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("UnregisterHotKey"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_ACCEL
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool wxWindowMSW::HandleHotKey(WXWPARAM wParam, WXLPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
int hotkeyId = wParam;
|
|
|
|
int virtualKey = HIWORD(lParam);
|
|
|
|
int win_modifiers = LOWORD(lParam);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxKeyEvent event(CreateKeyEvent(wxEVT_HOTKEY, virtualKey, wParam, lParam));
|
|
|
|
event.SetId(hotkeyId);
|
|
|
|
event.m_shiftDown = (win_modifiers & MOD_SHIFT) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_controlDown = (win_modifiers & MOD_CONTROL) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_altDown = (win_modifiers & MOD_ALT) != 0;
|
|
|
|
event.m_metaDown = (win_modifiers & MOD_WIN) != 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return GetEventHandler()->ProcessEvent(event);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_ACCEL
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // wxUSE_HOTKEY
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Not tested under WinCE
|
|
|
|
#ifndef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// this class installs a message hook which really wakes up our idle processing
|
|
|
|
// each time a WM_NULL is received (wxWakeUpIdle does this), even if we're
|
|
|
|
// sitting inside a local modal loop (e.g. a menu is opened or scrollbar is
|
|
|
|
// being dragged or even inside ::MessageBox()) and so don't control message
|
|
|
|
// dispatching otherwise
|
|
|
|
class wxIdleWakeUpModule : public wxModule
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
public:
|
|
|
|
virtual bool OnInit()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
ms_hMsgHookProc = ::SetWindowsHookEx
|
|
|
|
(
|
|
|
|
WH_GETMESSAGE,
|
|
|
|
&wxIdleWakeUpModule::MsgHookProc,
|
|
|
|
NULL,
|
|
|
|
GetCurrentThreadId()
|
|
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if ( !ms_hMsgHookProc )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxLogLastError(_T("SetWindowsHookEx(WH_GETMESSAGE)"));
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
virtual void OnExit()
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
::UnhookWindowsHookEx(wxIdleWakeUpModule::ms_hMsgHookProc);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
static LRESULT CALLBACK MsgHookProc(int nCode, WPARAM wParam, LPARAM lParam)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
MSG *msg = (MSG*)lParam;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// only process the message if it is actually going to be removed from
|
|
|
|
// the message queue, this prevents that the same event from being
|
|
|
|
// processed multiple times if now someone just called PeekMessage()
|
|
|
|
if ( msg->message == WM_NULL && wParam == PM_REMOVE )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxTheApp->ProcessPendingEvents();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
return CallNextHookEx(ms_hMsgHookProc, nCode, wParam, lParam);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
private:
|
|
|
|
static HHOOK ms_hMsgHookProc;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
DECLARE_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxIdleWakeUpModule)
|
|
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
HHOOK wxIdleWakeUpModule::ms_hMsgHookProc = 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
IMPLEMENT_DYNAMIC_CLASS(wxIdleWakeUpModule, wxModule)
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#endif // __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#ifdef __WXWINCE__
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_STATBOX
|
|
|
|
static void wxAdjustZOrder(wxWindow* parent)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
if (parent->IsKindOf(CLASSINFO(wxStaticBox)))
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
// Set the z-order correctly
|
|
|
|
SetWindowPos((HWND) parent->GetHWND(), HWND_BOTTOM, 0, 0, 0, 0, SWP_NOMOVE|SWP_NOSIZE);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
wxWindowList::compatibility_iterator current = parent->GetChildren().GetFirst();
|
|
|
|
while (current)
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
wxWindow *childWin = current->GetData();
|
|
|
|
wxAdjustZOrder(childWin);
|
|
|
|
current = current->GetNext();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// We need to adjust the z-order of static boxes in WinCE, to
|
|
|
|
// make 'contained' controls visible
|
|
|
|
void wxWindowMSW::OnInitDialog( wxInitDialogEvent& event )
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
|
|
#if wxUSE_STATBOX
|
|
|
|
wxAdjustZOrder(this);
|
|
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
event.Skip();
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
#endif
|